]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/doc/tm.texi
Remove enum before machine_mode
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
36 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
37 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
40 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
41 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
43 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
44 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
45 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
46 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
48 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
49 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
50 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
51 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
54 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
55 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
56 * Misc:: Everything else.
57 @end menu
58
59 @node Target Structure
60 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
61 @cindex target hooks
62 @cindex target functions
63
64 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
66 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
71 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
72 @smallexample
73 #include "target.h"
74 #include "target-def.h"
75
76 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
77
78 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
80
81 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
82 @end smallexample
83 @end deftypevar
84
85 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
86 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
87 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
88 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
89 @code{targetm} structure.
90
91 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
92 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
93 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
94 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
95 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
96 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
97 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
98
99 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
100 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
101 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
102 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
103 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
104 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
105 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
106 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
107 default definition is used.
108
109 @node Driver
110 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
111 @cindex driver
112 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
113
114 @c prevent bad page break with this line
115 You can control the compilation driver.
116
117 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
118 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
119 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
120
121 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
122 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
123 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
124 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
125 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
126 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
127
128 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
129 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
130 that the other specs are easier to write.
131
132 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
133 @end defmac
134
135 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
136 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
137 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
138 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
139 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
140
141 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
142 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
143 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
144 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
145 everywhere it occurs.
146
147 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
148 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
149 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
150
151 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
152 @end defmac
153
154 @defmac CPP_SPEC
155 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
156 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
157 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
158
159 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
160 @end defmac
161
162 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
163 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
164 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
165 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
166 @end defmac
167
168 @defmac CC1_SPEC
169 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
170 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
171 front ends.
172 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
173 for GCC to pass to front ends.
174
175 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
176 @end defmac
177
178 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
179 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
180 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
181 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
182
183 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
184 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
185 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
186 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
187 @end defmac
188
189 @defmac ASM_SPEC
190 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
191 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
192 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
193 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
194
195 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
196 @end defmac
197
198 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
199 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
200 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
201 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
202 an example of this.
203
204 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
205 @end defmac
206
207 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
208 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
209 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
210 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
211 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
212 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
213
214 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
215 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
216 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
217 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
218 @end defmac
219
220 @defmac LINK_SPEC
221 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
223 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
224
225 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
226 @end defmac
227
228 @defmac LIB_SPEC
229 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
230 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
231 command given to the linker.
232
233 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
234 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
235 @end defmac
236
237 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
238 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
239 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
240 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
241 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
242
243 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
244 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
245 @end defmac
246
247 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
248 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
249 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
250 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
251 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
252 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
253 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
254 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
255 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
256 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
257 @end defmac
258
259 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
260 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
261 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
262 generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
263 shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
264 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266 @end defmac
267
268 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273 @end defmac
274
275 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
276 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
277 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
285 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287 the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
290 @end defmac
291
292 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
293 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
296 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
298 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
300 @end defmac
301
302 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
303 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
306 @end defmac
307
308 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
309 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
311 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
312 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
313 @end defmac
314
315 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
316 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322 string constant that provides the specification.
323
324 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
327 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
328 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329 these definitions.
330
331 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334 used.
335
336 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
338 @smallexample
339 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
340 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
343 @end smallexample
344
345 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346 @smallexample
347 #undef CPP_SPEC
348 #define CPP_SPEC \
349 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
350 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
352 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356 @end smallexample
357
358 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361 @smallexample
362 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364 @end smallexample
365 @end defmac
366
367 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
368 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
370 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
371 @end defmac
372
373 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
374 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
376 @end defmac
377
378 @defmac POST_LINK_SPEC
379 Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker.
380 The default value of this macro is empty string.
381 @end defmac
382
383 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
384 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
385 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
386 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
387 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
388 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
389 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
390 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
391 @end defmac
392
393 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
394 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
395 @end deftypevr
396
397 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
398 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
399 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
400 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
401 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
402
403 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
404 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
405 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
406 @xref{Target Fragment}.
407 @end defmac
408
409 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
410 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
411 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
412 indicates an absolute file name.
413 @end defmac
414
415 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
416 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
417 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
418 when the compiler is built as a cross
419 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
420 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
421 @end defmac
422
423 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
424 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
425 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
426 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
427 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
428 is built as a cross compiler.
429 @end defmac
430
431 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
432 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
433 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
434 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
435 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
436 is built as a cross compiler.
437 @end defmac
438
439 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
440 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
441 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
442 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
443 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
444 is built as a cross compiler.
445 @end defmac
446
447 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
448 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
449 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
450 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
451 @end defmac
452
453 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
454 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
455 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
456 cross compiler.
457 @end defmac
458
459 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
460 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
461 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
462 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
463 initialize the necessary environment variables.
464 @end defmac
465
466 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
467 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
469 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
470 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
471 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
472
473 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
474 replacement.
475 @end defmac
476
477 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
478 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
479 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
480 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
481 @end defmac
482
483 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
484 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
485 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
486 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
487 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
488 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
489 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
490 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
491 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
492
493 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
494 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
495 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
496 for C++-only directories,
497 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
498 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
499 the array with a null element.
500
501 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
502 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
503 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
504 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
505
506 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
507
508 @smallexample
509 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
510 @{ \
511 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
512 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
513 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
515 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
516 @}
517 @end smallexample
518 @end defmac
519
520 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
521
522 @enumerate
523 @item
524 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
525
526 @item
527 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
528 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
529 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
530
531 @item
532 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
533
534 @item
535 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
536 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
537
538 @item
539 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
540
541 @item
542 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
543
544 @item
545 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
546 compiler.
547 @end enumerate
548
549 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
550
551 @enumerate
552 @item
553 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
554
555 @item
556 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
557 value based on the installed toolchain location.
558
559 @item
560 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
561 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
562
563 @item
564 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
565 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
566
567 @item
568 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
569
570 @item
571 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
572 compiler.
573
574 @item
575 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
576 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
577
578 @item
579 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
580 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
581
582 @item
583 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
584 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
585 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
586
587 @item
588 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
589 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
590 @file{/lib/}.
591
592 @item
593 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
594 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
595 @file{/usr/lib/}.
596 @end enumerate
597
598 @node Run-time Target
599 @section Run-time Target Specification
600 @cindex run-time target specification
601 @cindex predefined macros
602 @cindex target specifications
603
604 @c prevent bad page break with this line
605 Here are run-time target specifications.
606
607 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
608 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
609 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
610 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
611 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
612 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
613 finished command line option processing your code can use those
614 results freely.
615
616 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
617 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
618 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
619 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
620
621 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
622 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
623 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
624 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
625 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
626 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
627 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
628 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
629 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
630 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
631
632 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
633 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
634 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
635 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
636 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
637 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
638 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
639 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
640 preprocessing.
641 @end defmac
642
643 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
644 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645 and is used for the target operating system instead.
646 @end defmac
647
648 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
649 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
650 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
651 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
652 it yourself.
653 @end defmac
654
655 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
656 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
657 any target-specific headers.
658 @end deftypevar
659
660 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
661 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
662 Its default setting is 0.
663 @end deftypevr
664
665 @cindex optional hardware or system features
666 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
667
668 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
669 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
670 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
671 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
672 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
673 definition does nothing but return true.
674
675 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
676 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
677 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
678 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
679 via attributes).
680 @end deftypefn
681
682 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
683 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
684 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
685 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
686 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
687 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
688 default definition does nothing but return false.
689
690 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
691 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
692 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
693 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
694 @end deftypefn
695
696 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
697 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
698 @end deftypefn
699
700 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
701 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
702 @end deftypefn
703
704 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
705 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
706 @end deftypefn
707
708 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
709 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
710 @end deftypefn
711
712 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
713 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
714 @end deftypefn
715
716 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
717 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
718 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
719 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
720 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
721 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
722 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
723 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
724 @end deftypefn
725
726 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
727 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
728 but is only used in the C
729 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
730 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
731 frontends.
732 @end defmac
733
734 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
735 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
736 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
737 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
738 options are processed once
739 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
740 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
741 options passed explicitly.
742
743 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
744 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
745 @code{optimize} attribute.
746 @end deftypevr
747
748 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
749 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
750 @end deftypefn
751
752 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
753 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
754 @end deftypefn
755
756 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
757 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
758 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
759 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
760 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
761 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
762
763 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
764 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
765 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
766 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
767 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
768 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
769 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
770
771 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
772 is 0.
773 @end defmac
774
775 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
776 Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
777 @end deftypefn
778
779 @node Per-Function Data
780 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
781 @cindex per-function data
782 @cindex data structures
783
784 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
785 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
786 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
787 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
788 when another one comes along.
789
790 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
791 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
792 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
793 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
794 to their own specific data.
795
796 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
797 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
798 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
799 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
800
801 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
802 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
803 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
804 function, for level 0.
805
806 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
807 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
808 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
809 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
810 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
811 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
812 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
813 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
814 longer supported.
815
816 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
817 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
818 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
819 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
820 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
821 @end defmac
822
823 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
824 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
825 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
826 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
827 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
828 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
829
830 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
831 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
832 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
833 @end deftypevar
834
835 @node Storage Layout
836 @section Storage Layout
837 @cindex storage layout
838
839 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
840 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
841 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
842 @xref{Run-time Target}.
843
844 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
845 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
846 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
847 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
848 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
849 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
850 macro need not be a constant.
851
852 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
853 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
854 @end defmac
855
856 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
857 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
858 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
859 @end defmac
860
861 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
862 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
863 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
864 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
865 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
866 macro need not be a constant.
867 @end defmac
868
869 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
870 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
871 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
872 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
873 the order of words in memory.
874 @end defmac
875
876 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
877 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
878 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
879 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
880 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
881
882 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
883 multi-word integers.
884 @end defmac
885
886 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
887 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
888 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
889 @end defmac
890
891 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
892 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
893 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
894 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
895 @end defmac
896
897 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
898 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
899 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
900 @end defmac
901
902 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
903 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
904 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
905 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
906 @end defmac
907
908 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
909 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
910 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
911 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
912 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
913 @end defmac
914
915 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
916 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
917 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
918 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
919 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
920 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
921 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
922
923 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
924 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
925 @end defmac
926
927 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
928 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
929 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
930 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
931 scalar type.
932
933 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
934 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
935 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
936 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
937 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
938 counterparts.
939
940 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
941 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
942 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
943 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
944 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
945 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
946
947 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
948 @end defmac
949
950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum flt_eval_method} TARGET_C_EXCESS_PRECISION (enum excess_precision_type @var{type})
951 Return a value, with the same meaning as the C99 macro @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} that describes which excess precision should be applied. @var{type} is either @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD}. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, the target should return which precision and range operations will be implictly evaluated in regardless of the excess precision explicitly added. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} and @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, the target should return the explicit excess precision that should be added depending on the value set for @option{-fexcess-precision=@r{[}standard@r{|}fast@r{]}}. Note that unpredictable explicit excess precision does not make sense, so a target should never return @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD_UNPREDICTABLE} when @var{type} is @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}.
952 @end deftypefn
953
954 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
955 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
956 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
957 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
958 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
959 pointer} types.
960
961 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
962 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
963 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
964 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
965 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
966 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
967 the signedness may be different.
968
969 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
970
971 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
972 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
973 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
974 @end deftypefn
975
976 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
977 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
978 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
979 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
980 size of an integer.
981 @end defmac
982
983 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
984 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
985 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
986 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
987 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
988 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
989 @end defmac
990
991 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
992 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
993 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
994 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
995 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
996 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
997 @end defmac
998
999 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1000 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1001 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1002 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1003 @end defmac
1004
1005 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1006 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1007 @end defmac
1008
1009 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1010 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1011 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1012 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1013 @end defmac
1014
1015 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1016 If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1017 that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1018 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1019 @end deftypevr
1020
1021 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1022 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1023 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1024 @end defmac
1025
1026 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1027 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1028 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1029 @end defmac
1030
1031 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1032 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1033 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1034 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1035 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1036 @end defmac
1037
1038 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1039 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1040 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1041 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1042 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1043 @end defmac
1044
1045 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{type}, @var{computed})
1046 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} of
1047 type @var{type} if the alignment computed in the usual way (including
1048 applying of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1049 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1050 field alignment has not been set by the
1051 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. Note that @var{field}
1052 may be @code{NULL_TREE} in case we just query for the minimum alignment
1053 of a field of type @var{type} in structure context.
1054 @end defmac
1055
1056 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1057 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1058 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1059
1060 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1061
1062 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1063 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1064 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1065 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1066 @end defmac
1067
1068 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1069 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1070 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1071 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1072 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1073
1074 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1075 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1076 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1077 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1078 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1079 @end defmac
1080
1081 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1082 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1083 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1084 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1085 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1086
1087 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1088
1089 @findex strcpy
1090 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1091 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1092 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1093 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1094 @end defmac
1095
1096 @defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1097 Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1098 some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1099 AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1100 must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1101
1102 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1103 @end defmac
1104
1105 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1106 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1107 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1108 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1109 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1110 align the object.
1111
1112 The default definition just returns @var{basic-align}.
1113
1114 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1115 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1116 constants can be done inline.
1117 @end defmac
1118
1119 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1120 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1121 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1122 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1123 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1124
1125 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1126
1127 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1128 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1129
1130 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1131 @end defmac
1132
1133 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1134 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1135 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1136 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1137 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1138 the vector element type.
1139 @end deftypefn
1140
1141 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1142 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1143 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1144 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1145 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1146 align the slot.
1147
1148 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1149 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1150 be used.
1151
1152 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1153 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1154
1155 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1156 @end defmac
1157
1158 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1159 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1160 variable @var{decl}.
1161
1162 If this macro is not defined, then
1163 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1164 is used.
1165
1166 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1167 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1168
1169 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1170 @end defmac
1171
1172 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1173 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1174 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1175 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1176
1177 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1178 @end defmac
1179
1180 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1181 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1182 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1183
1184 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1185 @end defmac
1186
1187 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1188 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1189 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1190
1191 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1192 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1193 @end defmac
1194
1195 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1196 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1197 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1198 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1199 @end defmac
1200
1201 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1202 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1203 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1204
1205 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1206 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1207 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1208 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1209 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1210
1211 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1212 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1213 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1214 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1215
1216 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1217 structure.
1218
1219 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1220 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1221
1222 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1223 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1224 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1225 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1226
1227 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1228 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1229 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1230
1231 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1232 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1233 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1234
1235 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1236 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1237 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1238
1239 @smallexample
1240 struct foo1
1241 @{
1242 char x;
1243 char :0;
1244 char y;
1245 @};
1246
1247 struct foo2
1248 @{
1249 char x;
1250 int :0;
1251 char y;
1252 @};
1253
1254 main ()
1255 @{
1256 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1257 sizeof (struct foo1));
1258 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1259 sizeof (struct foo2));
1260 exit (0);
1261 @}
1262 @end smallexample
1263
1264 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1265 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1266 @end defmac
1267
1268 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1269 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1270 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1271 @end defmac
1272
1273 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1274 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1275 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1276 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1277 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1278 @end deftypefn
1279
1280 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1281 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1282 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1283 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1284
1285 The default is @code{false}.
1286 @end deftypefn
1287
1288 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1289 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1290 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1291
1292 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1293 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1294 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1295 retain the field's mode.
1296
1297 Normally, this is not needed.
1298 @end deftypefn
1299
1300 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1301 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1302 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1303 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1304 @var{specified}.
1305
1306 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1307 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1308 @end defmac
1309
1310 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1311 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1312 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1313 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1314 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1315 (DImode)} is assumed.
1316 @end defmac
1317
1318 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1319 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1320 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1321 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1322 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1323 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1324 having its mode specified.
1325
1326 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1327 would most commonly define this macro if the
1328 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1329 64-bit mode.
1330 @end defmac
1331
1332 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1333 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1334 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1335 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1336
1337 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1338 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1339 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1340 @end defmac
1341
1342 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1343 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1344 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1345 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1346 targets.
1347 @end deftypefn
1348
1349 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1350 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1351 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1352 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1353 targets.
1354 @end deftypefn
1355
1356 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1357 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1358 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1359 @end deftypefn
1360
1361 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1362 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1363 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1364 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1365 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1366 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1367 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1368 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1369 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1370 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1371 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1372 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1373
1374 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1375 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1376 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1377 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1378 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1379 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1380 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1381
1382 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1383 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1384 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1385 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1386 may affect its placement.
1387 @end deftypefn
1388
1389 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1390 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1391 @end deftypefn
1392
1393 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1394 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1395 @end deftypefn
1396
1397 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1398 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1399 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1400 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1401 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1402 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1403 usage.
1404 @end deftypefn
1405
1406 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1407 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1408 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1409 @end deftypefn
1410
1411 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1412 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1413 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1414 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1415 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1416 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1417 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1418 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1419 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1420 string constant.
1421
1422 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1423 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1424 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1425 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1426 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1427 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1428 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1429 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1430 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1431 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1432 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1433 spaces in your string.
1434
1435 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1436 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1437 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1438 before mangling.
1439
1440 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1441 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1442 types.
1443 @end deftypefn
1444
1445 @node Type Layout
1446 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1447
1448 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1449 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1450 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1451 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1452
1453 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1454 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1455 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1456 @end defmac
1457
1458 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1459 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1460 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1461 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1462 unit.)
1463 @end defmac
1464
1465 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1466 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1467 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1468 @end defmac
1469
1470 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1471 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1472 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1473 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1474 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1475 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1476 @end defmac
1477
1478 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1479 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1480 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1481 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1482 macro must be at least 64.
1483 @end defmac
1484
1485 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1486 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1487 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1488 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1489 @end defmac
1490
1491 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1492 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1493 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1494 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1495 @end defmac
1496
1497 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1498 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1499 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1500 @end defmac
1501
1502 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1503 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1504 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1505 words.
1506 @end defmac
1507
1508 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1509 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1510 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1511 words.
1512 @end defmac
1513
1514 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1515 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1516 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1517 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1518 @end defmac
1519
1520 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1521 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1522 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1524 @end defmac
1525
1526 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1527 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1528 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1530 @end defmac
1531
1532 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1533 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1534 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1536 @end defmac
1537
1538 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1539 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1540 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1541 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1542 @end defmac
1543
1544 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1545 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1546 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1547 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1548 @end defmac
1549
1550 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1551 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1552 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1553 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1554 @end defmac
1555
1556 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1557 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1558 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1559 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1560 @end defmac
1561
1562 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1563 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1564 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1565 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1566 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1567 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1568 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1569 @end defmac
1570
1571 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1572 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1573 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1574 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1575 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1576 is the default.
1577 @end defmac
1578
1579 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1580 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1581 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1582 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1583 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1584 @end defmac
1585
1586 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1587 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1588 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1589 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1590 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1591
1592 The default is to return false.
1593 @end deftypefn
1594
1595 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1596 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1597 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1598 contents of the string.
1599
1600 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1601 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1602 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1603 of the data type names defined in the function
1604 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1605 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1606 compiler to crash on startup.
1607
1608 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1609 int"}.
1610 @end defmac
1611
1612 @defmac SIZETYPE
1613 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1614 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1615 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1616 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1617 is extracted.
1618
1619 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1620
1621 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1622 @end defmac
1623
1624 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1625 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1626 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1627 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1628 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1629
1630 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1631 @end defmac
1632
1633 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1634 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1635 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1636 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1637 information.
1638
1639 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1640 @end defmac
1641
1642 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1643 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1644 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1645 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1646 @end defmac
1647
1648 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1649 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1650 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1651 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1652 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1653 information.
1654
1655 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1656 @end defmac
1657
1658 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1659 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1660 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1661 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1662 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1663
1664 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1665 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1666 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1667 @end defmac
1668
1669 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1670 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1671 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1672 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1673 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1674
1675 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1676 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1677 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1678 int}.
1679 @end defmac
1680
1681 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1682 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1683 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1684 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1685 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1686 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1687 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1688 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1689 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1690 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1691 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1692 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1693 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1694 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1695 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1696 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1697 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1698 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1699 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1700 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1701 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1702 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1703 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1704 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1705 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1706 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1707 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1708 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1709 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1710 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1711 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1712 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1713 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1714 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1715 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1716 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1717 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1718
1719 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1720 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1721 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1722 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1723 these macros are null pointers.
1724 @end defmac
1725
1726 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1727 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1728 that looks like:
1729
1730 @smallexample
1731 struct @{
1732 union @{
1733 void (*fn)();
1734 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1735 @};
1736 ptrdiff_t delta;
1737 @};
1738 @end smallexample
1739
1740 @noindent
1741 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1742 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1743 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1744 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1745 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1746 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1747 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1748 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1749
1750 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1751 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1752 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1753 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1754 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1755 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1756 architecture, you should define this macro to
1757 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1758
1759 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1760 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1761 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1762 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1763 @end defmac
1764
1765 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1766 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1767 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1768 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1769 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1770 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1771 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1772
1773 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1774 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1775 @end defmac
1776
1777 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1778 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1779 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1780 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1781 when special alignment is necessary. */
1782 @end defmac
1783
1784 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1785 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1786 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1787 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1788 of words in each data entry.
1789 @end defmac
1790
1791 @node Registers
1792 @section Register Usage
1793 @cindex register usage
1794
1795 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1796 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1797
1798 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1799 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1800 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1801 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1802 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1803
1804 @menu
1805 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1806 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1807 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1808 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1809 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1810 @end menu
1811
1812 @node Register Basics
1813 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1814
1815 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1816 Registers have various characteristics.
1817
1818 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1819 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1820 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1821 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1822 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1823 @end defmac
1824
1825 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1826 @cindex fixed register
1827 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1828 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1829 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1830 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1831 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1832 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1833 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1834
1835 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1836 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1837 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1838
1839 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1840 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1841 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1842 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1843 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1844 @end defmac
1845
1846 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1847 @cindex call-used register
1848 @cindex call-clobbered register
1849 @cindex call-saved register
1850 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1851 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1852 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1853 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1854 function calls.
1855
1856 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1857 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1858 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1859 @end defmac
1860
1861 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1862 @cindex call-used register
1863 @cindex call-clobbered register
1864 @cindex call-saved register
1865 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1866 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1867 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1868 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1869 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1870 @end defmac
1871
1872 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1873 @cindex call-used register
1874 @cindex call-clobbered register
1875 @cindex call-saved register
1876 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1877 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1878 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1879 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1880 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1881 @end defmac
1882
1883 @findex fixed_regs
1884 @findex call_used_regs
1885 @findex global_regs
1886 @findex reg_names
1887 @findex reg_class_contents
1888 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1889 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1890 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1891 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1892 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1893 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as boolean vectors).
1894 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1895 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1896 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1897 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1898 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1899 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1900 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1901 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1902 command options have been applied.
1903
1904 @cindex disabling certain registers
1905 @cindex controlling register usage
1906 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1907 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1908 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1909 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1910 @code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1911 that shouldn't be used.
1912
1913 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1914 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1915 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1916 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1917 @end deftypefn
1918
1919 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1920 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1921 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1922 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1923 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1924 outbound register.
1925 @end defmac
1926
1927 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1928 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1929 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1930 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1931 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1932 register.
1933 @end defmac
1934
1935 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1936 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1937 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1938 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1939 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1940 gotos.
1941 @end defmac
1942
1943 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1944 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1945 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1946 @end defmac
1947
1948 @node Allocation Order
1949 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1950 @cindex order of register allocation
1951 @cindex register allocation order
1952
1953 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1954 Registers are allocated in order.
1955
1956 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1957 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1958 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1959 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1960
1961 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1962 (all else being equal).
1963
1964 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1965 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1966 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1967 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1968 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1969 @end defmac
1970
1971 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1972 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1973 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1974
1975 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1976 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1977 register; and so on.
1978
1979 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1980 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1981
1982 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1983 @end defmac
1984
1985 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1986 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1987 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1988 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1989 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
1990 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
1991 macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
1992 @end defmac
1993
1994 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
1995 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
1996 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
1997 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
1998 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
1999 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2000 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2001 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2002
2003 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2004 @end defmac
2005
2006 @node Values in Registers
2007 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2008
2009 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2010 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2011 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2012
2013 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2014 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2015 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2016 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2017 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2018 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2019
2020 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2021 definition of this macro is
2022
2023 @smallexample
2024 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2025 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2026 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2027 @end smallexample
2028 @end defmac
2029
2030 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2031 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2032 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2033 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2034 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2035 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2036 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2037
2038 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2039 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2040 nonzero.
2041
2042 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2043 @code{subreg_get_info}
2044 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2045 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2046 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2047 registers and so not be representable.
2048 @end defmac
2049
2050 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2051 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2052 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2053 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2054 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2055 @end defmac
2056
2057 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2058 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2059 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2060 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2061 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2062 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2063 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2064 @end defmac
2065
2066 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2067 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2068 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2069 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2070 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2071
2072 @smallexample
2073 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2074 @end smallexample
2075
2076 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2077 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2078
2079 @cindex register pairs
2080 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2081 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2082 odd register numbers for such modes.
2083
2084 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2085 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2086 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2087 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2088
2089 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2090 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2091 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2092 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2093 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2094 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2095 to be tieable.
2096
2097 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2098 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2099 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2100 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2101 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2102 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2103
2104 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2105 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2106 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2107 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2108 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2109 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2110 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2111 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2112 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2113
2114 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2115 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2116 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2117 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2118 constraints for those instructions.
2119
2120 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2121 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2122 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2123 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2124 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2125 @end defmac
2126
2127 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2128 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2129 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2130
2131 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2132 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2133 handler.
2134
2135 The default is always nonzero.
2136 @end defmac
2137
2138 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2139 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2140 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2141
2142 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2143 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2144 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2145 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2146 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2147 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2148
2149 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2150 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2151 allocation.
2152 @end defmac
2153
2154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2155 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2156 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2157
2158 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2159 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2160
2161 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2162 @end deftypefn
2163
2164 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2165 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2166 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2167 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2168 @end defmac
2169
2170 @node Leaf Functions
2171 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2172
2173 @cindex leaf functions
2174 @cindex functions, leaf
2175 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2176 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2177 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2178 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2179 normally arrive.
2180
2181 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2182 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2183 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2184 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2185 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2186 functions''.
2187
2188 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2189 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2190 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2191 accomplish this.
2192
2193 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2194 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2195 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2196 function treatment.
2197
2198 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2199 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2200 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2201 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2202 in this vector.
2203
2204 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2205 the treatment of leaf functions.
2206 @end defmac
2207
2208 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2209 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2210 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2211
2212 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2213 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2214 will cause the compiler to abort.
2215
2216 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2217 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2218 this.
2219 @end defmac
2220
2221 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2222 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2223 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2224 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2225 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2226 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2227 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2228 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2229 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2230 functions which only use leaf registers.
2231 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2232 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2233 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2234 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2235 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2236
2237 @node Stack Registers
2238 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2239
2240 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2241 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2242 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2243 stack.
2244
2245 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2246 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2247 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2248 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2249 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2250 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2251 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2252
2253 @defmac STACK_REGS
2254 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2255 @end defmac
2256
2257 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2258 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2259 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2260 @end defmac
2261
2262 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2263 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2264 of the stack.
2265 @end defmac
2266
2267 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2268 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2269 the stack.
2270 @end defmac
2271
2272 @node Register Classes
2273 @section Register Classes
2274 @cindex register class definitions
2275 @cindex class definitions, register
2276
2277 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2278 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2279 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2280 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2281
2282 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2283 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2284 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2285
2286 @findex ALL_REGS
2287 @findex NO_REGS
2288 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2289 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2290 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2291 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2292
2293 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2294 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2295 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2296 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2297 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2298 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2299
2300 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2301 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2302
2303 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2304 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2305 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2306 them in operand constraints.
2307
2308 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2309 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2310 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2311 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2312 (@pxref{Costs}).
2313
2314 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2315 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2316 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2317 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2318 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2319 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2320 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2321
2322 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2323 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2324 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2325 in their union.
2326
2327 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2328 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2329 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2330 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2331 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2332
2333 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2334 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2335 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2336 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2337 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2338 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2339 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2340 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2341 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2342
2343 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2344 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2345 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2346 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2347 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2348 tells how many classes there are.
2349
2350 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2351 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2352 in many of the tables described below.
2353 @end deftp
2354
2355 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2356 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2357
2358 @smallexample
2359 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2360 @end smallexample
2361 @end defmac
2362
2363 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2364 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2365 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2366 @end defmac
2367
2368 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2369 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2370 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2371 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2372 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2373
2374 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2375 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2376 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2377 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2378 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2379 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2380 so on.
2381 @end defmac
2382
2383 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2384 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2385 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2386 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2387 register.
2388 @end defmac
2389
2390 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2391 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2392 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2393 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2394 @end defmac
2395
2396 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2397 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2398 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2399 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2400 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2401 @end defmac
2402
2403 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2404 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2405 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2406 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2407 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2408 @end defmac
2409
2410 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2411 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2412 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2413 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2414 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2415 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2416 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2417 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2418 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2419 @end defmac
2420
2421 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2422 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2423 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2424 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2425 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2426 @end defmac
2427
2428 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2429 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2430 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2431 @end defmac
2432
2433 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2434 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2435 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2436 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2437 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2438 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2439 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2440 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2441 @code{address_operand}.
2442 @end defmac
2443
2444 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2445 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2446 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2447 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2448 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2449 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2450 than other base register uses.
2451
2452 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2453 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2454 @end defmac
2455
2456 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2457 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2458 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2459 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2460 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2461 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2462 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2463 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2464 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2465 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2466 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2467 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2468 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2469 @end defmac
2470
2471 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2472 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2473 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2474 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2475 allocated such a hard register.
2476
2477 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2478 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2479 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2480 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2481 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2482 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2483 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2484 only if neither labeling works.
2485 @end defmac
2486
2487 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2488 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2489 @end deftypefn
2490
2491 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2492 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2493 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2494 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2495 another, smaller class.
2496
2497 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2498
2499 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2500 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2501 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2502 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2503 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2504
2505 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2506 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2507 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2508 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2509 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2510 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2511 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2512 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2513 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2514 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2515 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2516
2517 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2518 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2519 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2520 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2521 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2522 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2523 @end deftypefn
2524
2525 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2526 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2527 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2528 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2529 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2530 safe:
2531
2532 @smallexample
2533 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2534 @end smallexample
2535
2536 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2537 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2538 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2539 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2540 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2541
2542 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2543 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2544 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2545 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2546 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2547 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2548 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2549 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant cannot be loaded
2550 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2551 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2552 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2553
2554 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2555 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2556 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2557 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2558 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2559 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2560 @end defmac
2561
2562 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2563 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2564 input reloads.
2565
2566 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2567 argument.
2568
2569 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2570 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2571 @end deftypefn
2572
2573 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2574 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2575 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2576 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2577 ordinarily be used.
2578
2579 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2580 there are certain modes that simply cannot go in certain reload classes.
2581
2582 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2583 smaller class.
2584
2585 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2586 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2587 @end defmac
2588
2589 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2590 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2591 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2592 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2593 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2594 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2595 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2596 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2597 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2598 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2599 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2600 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2601 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2602
2603 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2604 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2605 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2606 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2607 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2608 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2609 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2610 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2611 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2612 of the scratch register(s).
2613
2614 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2615
2616 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2617 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2618 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2619 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2620 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2621
2622 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2623 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2624 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2625 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2626 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2627 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2628
2629 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2630 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2631 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2632 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2633 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2634
2635 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2636 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2637 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2638 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2639 single-register-class
2640 @c [later: or memory]
2641 output constraint.
2642
2643 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2644 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2645 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2646 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2647
2648 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2649 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2650 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2651 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2652 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2653 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2654 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2655 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2656
2657
2658 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2659 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2660 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2661 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2662
2663 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2664 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2665 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2666
2667 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2668 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2669 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2670 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2671 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2672 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2673 @end deftypefn
2674
2675 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2676 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2677 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2678 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2679 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2680
2681 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2682 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2683 reload phase that it may
2684 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2685 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2686 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2687 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2688 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2689 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2690
2691 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2692 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2693 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2694 class required. If the
2695 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2696 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2697 macros identically.
2698
2699 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2700 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2701 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2702 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2703 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2704
2705 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2706 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2707 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2708 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2709 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2710 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2711 register.
2712
2713 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2714 register that
2715 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2716 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2717 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2718 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2719 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2720
2721 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2722 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2723 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2724 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2725
2726 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2727 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2728 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2729 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2730 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2731 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2732 general registers.
2733 @end defmac
2734
2735 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2736 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2737 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2738 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2739 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2740 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2741 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2742
2743 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2744 @end defmac
2745
2746 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2747 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2748 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2749 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2750 defined by this macro.
2751
2752 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2753 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2754 @end defmac
2755
2756 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2757 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2758 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2759 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2760 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2761 same as that of @var{mode}.
2762
2763 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2764 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2765 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2766 registers.
2767
2768 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2769 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2770 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2771 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2772 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2773 details.
2774
2775 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2776 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2777 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2778 @end defmac
2779
2780 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2781 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2782 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2783 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2784
2785 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2786 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2787 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2788 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2789 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2790
2791 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2792 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2793 pressure.
2794 @end deftypefn
2795
2796 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2797 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2798 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2799
2800 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2801 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2802 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2803 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2804 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2805
2806 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2807 in the reload pass.
2808
2809 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2810 in words.
2811 @end deftypefn
2812
2813 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2814 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2815 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2816
2817 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2818 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2819 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2820 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2821
2822 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2823 in the reload pass.
2824 @end defmac
2825
2826 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2827 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2828 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2829
2830 For example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2831 floating-point registers on Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2832 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2833 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2834 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2835 as below:
2836
2837 @smallexample
2838 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2839 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2840 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2841 @end smallexample
2842
2843 Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,
2844 if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{class} are wider
2845 than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the
2846 mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load
2847 or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will
2848 eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.
2849 Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the
2850 entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial
2851 value that the middle-end intended.
2852
2853 @end defmac
2854
2855 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t}, @var{reg_class_t})
2856 A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2857 allocno and best class calculated by IRA.
2858
2859 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2860 @end deftypefn
2861
2862 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2863 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. The default version of this target hook returns true. New ports should use LRA, and existing ports are encouraged to convert.
2864 @end deftypefn
2865
2866 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2867 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2868 @end deftypefn
2869
2870 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2871 A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2872 @end deftypefn
2873
2874 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2875 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2876 @end deftypefn
2877
2878 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2879 A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2880 substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2881 register allocation.
2882 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2883 On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2884 machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2885 as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2886 @end deftypefn
2887
2888 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{disp}, rtx *@var{offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2889 A target hook which returns @code{true} if *@var{disp} is
2890 legitimezed to valid address displacement with subtracting *@var{offset}
2891 at memory mode @var{mode}.
2892 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2893 This hook will benefit machines with limited base plus displacement
2894 addressing.
2895 @end deftypefn
2896
2897 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
2898 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2899 @end deftypefn
2900
2901 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDITIONAL_ALLOCNO_CLASS_P (reg_class_t)
2902 This hook should return @code{true} if given class of registers should be an allocno class in any way. Usually RA uses only one register class from all classes containing the same register set. In some complicated cases, you need to have two or more such classes as allocno ones for RA correct work. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{false} for all inputs.
2903 @end deftypefn
2904
2905 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2906 This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2907 @end deftypefn
2908
2909 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPUTE_PRESSURE_CLASSES (enum reg_class *@var{pressure_classes})
2910 A target hook which lets a backend compute the set of pressure classes to be used by those optimization passes which take register pressure into account, as opposed to letting IRA compute them. It returns the number of register classes stored in the array @var{pressure_classes}.
2911 @end deftypefn
2912
2913 @node Stack and Calling
2914 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2915 @cindex calling conventions
2916
2917 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2918 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2919
2920 @menu
2921 * Frame Layout::
2922 * Exception Handling::
2923 * Stack Checking::
2924 * Frame Registers::
2925 * Elimination::
2926 * Stack Arguments::
2927 * Register Arguments::
2928 * Scalar Return::
2929 * Aggregate Return::
2930 * Caller Saves::
2931 * Function Entry::
2932 * Profiling::
2933 * Tail Calls::
2934 * Shrink-wrapping separate components::
2935 * Stack Smashing Protection::
2936 * Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
2937 @end menu
2938
2939 @node Frame Layout
2940 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2941 @cindex stack frame layout
2942 @cindex frame layout
2943
2944 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2945 Here is the basic stack layout.
2946
2947 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2948 Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2949 pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
2950 @end defmac
2951
2952 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
2953 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2954 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
2955 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2956
2957 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2958 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2959 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2960 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2961 space for the next item on the stack.
2962
2963 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2964 true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2965 which is often wrong.
2966 @end defmac
2967
2968 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2969 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
2970 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
2971 @end defmac
2972
2973 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2974 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2975 addresses on the stack.
2976 @end defmac
2977
2978 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2979 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2980
2981 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2982 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2983 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2984 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2985 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2986 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
2987 @end defmac
2988
2989 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2990 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
2991 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
2992
2993 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
2994 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2995 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2996 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
2997 @end defmac
2998
2999 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3000 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3001 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3002 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3003
3004 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3005 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3006 @end defmac
3007
3008 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3009 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3010 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3011 function.
3012
3013 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3014 the first argument's address.
3015 @end defmac
3016
3017 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3018 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3019 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3020
3021 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3022 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3023 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3024 @end defmac
3025
3026 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3027 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3028 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3029 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3030 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3031 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3032 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3033 @end defmac
3034
3035 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3036 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3037 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3038 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3039 itself.
3040
3041 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3042 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3043 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3044 @end defmac
3045
3046 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3047 A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3048 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3049 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3050 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3051 define this macro. The default is to do nothing.
3052 @end defmac
3053
3054 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3055 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3056 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3057 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3058 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3059 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3060 @end deftypefn
3061
3062 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3063 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3064 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3065 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3066 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3067 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3068 @end defmac
3069
3070 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3071 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3072 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3073 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3074 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3075 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
3076
3077 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3078 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3079 determine the return address of other frames.
3080 @end defmac
3081
3082 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3083 Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3084 stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3085 frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3086 @end defmac
3087
3088 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3089 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3090 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3091 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3092 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3093 the stack.
3094
3095 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3096 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3097
3098 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3099 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3100 @end defmac
3101
3102 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3103 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3104 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3105 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3106 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3107
3108 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3109 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3110 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3111 over time.
3112 @end defmac
3113
3114 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3115 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3116 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3117 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3118 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3119 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3120 @end defmac
3121
3122 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3123 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3124 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3125 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3126 @smallexample
3127 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3128 @end smallexample
3129 and
3130 @smallexample
3131 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3132 @end smallexample
3133 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3134 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3135 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3136 @end deftypefn
3137
3138 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3139 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3140 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3141 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3142 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3143 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3144
3145 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3146 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3147 @end defmac
3148
3149 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3150 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3151 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3152 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3153 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3154 during virtual register instantiation.
3155
3156 The default value for this macro is
3157 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3158 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3159 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3160 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3161 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3162
3163 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3164 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3165 DWARF 2.
3166 @end defmac
3167
3168 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3169 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3170 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3171 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3172 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3173
3174 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3175 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3176 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3177 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3178 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3179 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3180 should be defined.
3181 @end defmac
3182
3183 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3184 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3185 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3186 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3187 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3188 @end defmac
3189
3190 @node Exception Handling
3191 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3192 @cindex exception handling
3193
3194 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3195 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3196 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3197 @var{N} registers are usable.
3198
3199 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3200 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3201 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3202 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3203 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3204
3205 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3206 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3207 @end defmac
3208
3209 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3210 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3211 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3212 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3213 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3214
3215 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3216 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3217
3218 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3219 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3220 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3221 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3222 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3223 that provided by DWARF 2.
3224 @end defmac
3225
3226 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3227 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3228 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3229 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3230
3231 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3232 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3233 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3234 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3235 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3236 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3237 target call frame.
3238
3239 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3240 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3241 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3242
3243 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3244 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3245 @end defmac
3246
3247 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3248 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3249 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3250 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3251 using it to return to the exception handler.
3252 @end defmac
3253
3254 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3255 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3256 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3257 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3258 and so may be read-only.
3259
3260 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3261 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3262 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3263 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3264
3265 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3266 represented directly.
3267 @end defmac
3268
3269 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3270 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3271 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3272 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3273 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3274
3275 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3276 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3277 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3278 to be emitted.
3279 @end defmac
3280
3281 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3282 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3283 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3284 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3285 through signal frames.
3286
3287 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3288 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3289 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3290 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3291 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3292 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3293 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3294 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3295 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3296
3297 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3298 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3299 @end defmac
3300
3301 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3302 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3303 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3304 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3305
3306 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3307 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3308 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3309 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3310 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3311 be updated in @var{fs}.
3312 @end defmac
3313
3314 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3315 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3316 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3317 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3318 @end defmac
3319
3320 @node Stack Checking
3321 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3322
3323 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3324 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3325 three ways:
3326
3327 @enumerate
3328 @item
3329 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3330 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3331 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3332 other special processing.
3333
3334 @item
3335 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3336 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3337 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3338 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3339 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3340 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3341 approach below.
3342
3343 @item
3344 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3345 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3346 @end enumerate
3347
3348 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3349 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3350 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3351 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3352
3353 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3354 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3355 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3356 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3357 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3358 value of this macro is zero.
3359 @end defmac
3360
3361 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3362 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3363 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3364 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3365 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3366 @end defmac
3367
3368 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3369 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3370 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3371 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3372 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3373 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3374 @end defmac
3375
3376 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3377 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3378 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3379 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3380 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3381 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3382 default value of this macro is zero.
3383 @end defmac
3384
3385 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3386 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3387 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 4KB/8KB
3388 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3389 8KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most
3390 architectures and operating systems.
3391 @end defmac
3392
3393 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3394 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3395 in the opposite case.
3396
3397 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3398 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3399 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3400 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3401 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3402 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3403 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3404 @end defmac
3405
3406 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3407 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3408 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3409 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3410 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3411 use the default of four words.
3412 @end defmac
3413
3414 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3415 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3416 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3417 @option{-fstack-check}.
3418 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3419 normally not need to override that default.
3420 @end defmac
3421
3422 @need 2000
3423 @node Frame Registers
3424 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3425
3426 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3427 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3428
3429 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3430 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3431 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3432 the hardware determines which register this is.
3433 @end defmac
3434
3435 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3436 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3437 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3438 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3439 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3440 @end defmac
3441
3442 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3443 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3444 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3445 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3446 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3447 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3448 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3449 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3450 used for the frame pointer.
3451
3452 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3453 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3454 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3455 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3456 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3457 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3458 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3459
3460 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3461 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3462 @end defmac
3463
3464 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3465 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3466 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3467 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3468 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3469 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3470 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3471 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3472 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3473 @end defmac
3474
3475 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3476 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3477 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3478 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3479 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3480 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3481 @end defmac
3482
3483 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3484 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3485 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3486 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3487 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3488 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3489 @end defmac
3490
3491 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3492 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3493 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3494 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3495 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3496 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3497 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3498
3499 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3500 address from the stack.
3501 @end defmac
3502
3503 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3504 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3505 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3506 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3507 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3508 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3509 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3510 not be defined.
3511
3512 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3513
3514 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3515 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3516 @end defmac
3517
3518 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3519 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3520 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3521 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3522 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3523 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3524
3525 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3526
3527 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3528 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3529 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3530 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3531 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3532 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3533 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3534 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3535 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3536 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3537 to refer to those items.
3538 @end deftypefn
3539
3540 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3541 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3542 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3543 DWARF2 exception handling.
3544
3545 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3546 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3547 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3548 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3549 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3550 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3551 registers that are not call-saved.
3552
3553 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3554 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3555 @end defmac
3556
3557 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3558
3559 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3560 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3561
3562 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3563 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3564 @end defmac
3565
3566 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3567
3568 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3569 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3570 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3571 column number to use instead.
3572 @end defmac
3573
3574 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3575
3576 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3577 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3578 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3579 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3580 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3581
3582 @end defmac
3583
3584 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3585
3586 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3587 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3588 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3589 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3590 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3591
3592 @end defmac
3593
3594 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3595
3596 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3597 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3598 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3599 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3600
3601 @end defmac
3602
3603 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3604
3605 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3606 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3607 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3608 defined and 0 otherwise.
3609
3610 @end defmac
3611
3612 @node Elimination
3613 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3614
3615 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3616 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3617
3618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3619 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3620 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3621 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3622
3623 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3624 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3625 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3626 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3627 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3628 pointer.
3629
3630 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3631 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3632 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3633 @code{targetm.frame_pointer_required} returns. You don't need to worry about
3634 them.
3635
3636 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3637 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3638 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3639
3640 Default return value is @code{false}.
3641 @end deftypefn
3642
3643 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3644 This macro specifies a table of register pairs used to eliminate
3645 unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.
3646
3647 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3648 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3649
3650 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3651 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3652 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3653 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3654 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3655
3656 In this case, you might specify:
3657 @smallexample
3658 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3659 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3660 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3661 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3662 @end smallexample
3663
3664 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3665 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3666 @end defmac
3667
3668 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3669 This target hook should return @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3670 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3671 @var{to_reg}. This target hook will usually be @code{true}, since most of the
3672 cases preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3673 knows about.
3674
3675 Default return value is @code{true}.
3676 @end deftypefn
3677
3678 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3679 This macro returns the initial difference between the specified pair
3680 of registers. The value would be computed from information
3681 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3682 registers @code{df_regs_ever_live_p} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3683 @end defmac
3684
3685 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_COMPUTE_FRAME_LAYOUT (void)
3686 This target hook is called once each time the frame layout needs to be
3687 recalculated. The calculations can be cached by the target and can then
3688 be used by @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET} instead of re-computing the
3689 layout on every invocation of that hook. This is particularly useful
3690 for targets that have an expensive frame layout function. Implementing
3691 this callback is optional.
3692 @end deftypefn
3693
3694 @node Stack Arguments
3695 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3696 @cindex arguments on stack
3697 @cindex stack arguments
3698
3699 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3700 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3701 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3702
3703 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3704 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3705 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3706 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3707 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3708 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3709 @end deftypefn
3710
3711 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3712 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3713 outgoing arguments.
3714 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3715 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3716 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3717 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3718 @end defmac
3719
3720 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3721 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3722 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3723 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3724 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3725 @end defmac
3726
3727 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3728 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3729 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3730
3731 On some machines, the definition
3732
3733 @smallexample
3734 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3735 @end smallexample
3736
3737 @noindent
3738 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3739 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3740 alignment. Then the definition should be
3741
3742 @smallexample
3743 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3744 @end smallexample
3745
3746 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3747 @end defmac
3748
3749 @findex outgoing_args_size
3750 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3751 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3752 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3753 will be computed and placed into
3754 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3755 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3756 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3757
3758 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3759 is not proper.
3760 @end defmac
3761
3762 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3763 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3764 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3765 registers.
3766
3767 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3768 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3769 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3770 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3771 of the function.
3772
3773 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3774 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3775 which.
3776 @end defmac
3777 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3778 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3779
3780 @defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3781 Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3782 Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3783 is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3784 can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3785 @end defmac
3786
3787 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3788 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3789 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3790 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3791 if the function called is a library function.
3792
3793 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3794 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3795 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3796 @end defmac
3797
3798 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3799 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3800 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3801 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3802 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3803
3804 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3805 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3806 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3807 stack in its natural location.
3808 @end defmac
3809
3810 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3811 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3812 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3813 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3814
3815 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3816 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3817 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3818 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3819
3820 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3821 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3822 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3823 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3824 arguments (if known).
3825
3826 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3827 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3828 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3829 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3830 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3831 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3832
3833 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3834 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3835 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3836
3837 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3838 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3839 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3840 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3841 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3842 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3843 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3844 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3845 number of arguments.
3846 @end deftypefn
3847
3848 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3849 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3850 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3851 when compiling a function call.
3852
3853 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3854 have been accumulated.
3855
3856 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3857 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3858 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3859 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3860 appropriate.
3861 @end defmac
3862
3863 @node Register Arguments
3864 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3865 @cindex arguments in registers
3866 @cindex registers arguments
3867
3868 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3869 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3870 the stack.
3871
3872 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3873 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3874 register and if so, which register.
3875
3876 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3877 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3878 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3879 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3880 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3881 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3882 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3883 syntax error has previously occurred.
3884
3885 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3886 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3887 on the stack.
3888
3889 The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3890 passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3891 should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3892 @code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3893 for more information.
3894
3895 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3896 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3897 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3898 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3899 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3900 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3901 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3902 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3903 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3904 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3905 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3906 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3907 argument is also stored on the stack.
3908
3909 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3910 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3911 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3912
3913 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3914 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3915 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3916 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3917 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3918 @var{named} is @code{false}.
3919
3920 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3921 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3922 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3923 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3924 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3925 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3926 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3927 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3928 a register.
3929 @end deftypefn
3930
3931 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
3932 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3933 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3934 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3935 documentation.
3936 @end deftypefn
3937
3938 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3939 Define this hook if the caller and callee on the target have different
3940 views of where arguments are passed. Also define this hook if there are
3941 functions that are never directly called, but are invoked by the hardware
3942 and which have nonstandard calling conventions.
3943
3944 In this case @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
3945 which the caller passes the value, and
3946 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
3947 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
3948 arrive.
3949
3950 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} can also return arbitrary address
3951 computation using hard register, which can be forced into a register,
3952 so that it can be used to pass special arguments.
3953
3954 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
3955 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
3956 @end deftypefn
3957
3958 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
3959 This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
3960 for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
3961 @end deftypefn
3962
3963 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
3964 Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
3965 This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
3966 @end deftypefn
3967
3968 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3969 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
3970 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
3971 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3972 pushed on the stack.
3973
3974 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3975 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
3976 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3977 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3978 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3979 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
3980 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
3981
3982 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3983 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3984 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3985 @end deftypefn
3986
3987 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3988 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
3989 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
3990 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
3991 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
3992
3993 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3994 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3995 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3996 to that type.
3997 @end deftypefn
3998
3999 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4000 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4001 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4002 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4003 by the caller.
4004
4005 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4006 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4007 not be generated.
4008
4009 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4010 @end deftypefn
4011
4012 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4013 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4014 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4015 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4016 of bytes of argument so far.
4017
4018 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4019 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4020 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4021 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4022 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4023 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4024 @end defmac
4025
4026 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4027 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4028 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4029 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4030 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4031 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4032 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4033 @end defmac
4034
4035 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4036 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4037 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4038 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4039 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4040 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4041 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4042 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4043 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4044 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4045 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4046 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4047 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4048
4049 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4050 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4051 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4052 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4053 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4054 never both of them at once.
4055 @end defmac
4056
4057 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4058 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4059 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4060 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4061 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4062 0)} is used instead.
4063 @end defmac
4064
4065 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4066 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4067 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4068 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4069
4070 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4071 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4072 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4073 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4074 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4075 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4076 @end defmac
4077
4078 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4079 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4080 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4081 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4082 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4083 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4084
4085 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4086 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4087 used for arguments without any special help.
4088 @end deftypefn
4089
4090 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4091 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4092 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4093 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4094 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4095 top.
4096 @end defmac
4097
4098 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4099 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4100 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4101 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4102 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4103
4104 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4105 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4106 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4107
4108 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4109 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4110 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4111 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4112 @end defmac
4113
4114 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4115 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4116 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4117 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4118 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4119 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4120 @end defmac
4121
4122 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4123 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4124 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4125 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4126 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4127 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4128 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4129 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4130 required.
4131 @end defmac
4132
4133 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4134 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4135 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4136 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4137 @end deftypefn
4138
4139 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4140 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4141 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4142 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4143 value.
4144 @end deftypefn
4145
4146 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4147 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4148 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4149 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4150 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4151 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4152 stack.
4153 @end defmac
4154
4155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4156 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4157 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4158 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4159 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4160 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4161 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4162 point register.
4163
4164 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4165 false.
4166 @end deftypefn
4167
4168 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4169 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4170 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4171 @end deftypefn
4172
4173 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4174 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4175 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4176 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4177 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4178 variable.
4179 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4180 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4181 internal type.
4182 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4183 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4184 macro to iterate through all types.
4185 @end deftypefn
4186
4187 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4188 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4189 @var{fndecl}.
4190 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4191 @end deftypefn
4192
4193 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4194 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4195 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4196 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4197 @end deftypefn
4198
4199 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4200 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4201 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4202 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4203 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4204 @end deftypefn
4205
4206 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
4207 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4208 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4209 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4210 @end deftypefn
4211
4212 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
4213 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4214 @end deftypefn
4215
4216 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4217 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4218 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4219 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4220 must work.
4221
4222 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4223 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4224 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4225 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4226 @end deftypefn
4227
4228 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4229 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4230 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4231 must have move patterns for this mode.
4232 @end deftypefn
4233
4234 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4235 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4236 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4237 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4238 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4239
4240 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4241 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4242 has operations like:
4243
4244 @smallexample
4245 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4246 @end smallexample
4247
4248 where the return type is defined as:
4249
4250 @smallexample
4251 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4252 @{
4253 int8x8_t val[3];
4254 @} int8x8x3_t;
4255 @end smallexample
4256
4257 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4258 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4259 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4260 @end deftypefn
4261
4262 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4263 Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4264 floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4265 @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4266 hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4267 @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4268 @end deftypefn
4269
4270 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_FLOATN_MODE (int @var{n}, bool @var{extended})
4271 Define this to return the machine mode to use for the type
4272 @code{_Float@var{n}}, if @var{extended} is false, or the type
4273 @code{_Float@var{n}x}, if @var{extended} is true. If such a type
4274 is not supported, return @code{VOIDmode}. The default version of this
4275 hook returns @code{SFmode} for @code{_Float32}, @code{DFmode} for
4276 @code{_Float64} and @code{_Float32x} and @code{TFmode} for
4277 @code{_Float128}, if those modes exist and satisfy the requirements for
4278 those types and pass @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} and
4279 @code{TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}; for @code{_Float64x}, it
4280 returns the first of @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} that exists and
4281 satisfies the same requirements; for other types, it returns
4282 @code{VOIDmode}. The hook is only called for values of @var{n} and
4283 @var{extended} that are valid according to ISO/IEC TS 18661-3:2015; that
4284 is, @var{n} is one of 32, 64, 128, or, if @var{extended} is false, 16 or
4285 greater than 128 and a multiple of 32.
4286 @end deftypefn
4287
4288 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4289 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4290 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4291 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4292 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4293 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4294 for any mode.
4295
4296 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4297 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4298 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4299 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4300 insn.
4301
4302 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4303 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4304 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4305 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4306 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4307 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4308 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4309 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4310 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4311
4312 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4313 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4314 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4315 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4316 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4317 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4318 @end deftypefn
4319
4320 @node Scalar Return
4321 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4322 @cindex return values in registers
4323 @cindex values, returned by functions
4324 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4325
4326 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4327 values---values that can fit in registers.
4328
4329 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4330
4331 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4332 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4333 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4334 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4335 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4336 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4337 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4338 a function returns a value.
4339
4340 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4341 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4342 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4343 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4344 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4345 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4346 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4347 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4348 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4349 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4350 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4351 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4352
4353 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4354 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4355 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4356
4357 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4358 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4359 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4360 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4361 known.
4362
4363 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4364 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4365 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4366 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4367
4368 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4369 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4370 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4371 @end deftypefn
4372
4373 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4374 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4375 a new target instead.
4376 @end defmac
4377
4378 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4379 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4380 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4381
4382 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4383 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4384 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4385 compiled.
4386 @end defmac
4387
4388 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4389 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4390 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4391
4392 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4393 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4394 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4395
4396 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4397 @end deftypefn
4398
4399 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4400 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4401 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4402
4403 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4404 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4405 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4406 suffices:
4407
4408 @smallexample
4409 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4410 @end smallexample
4411
4412 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4413 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4414 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4415
4416 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4417 for a new target instead.
4418 @end defmac
4419
4420 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4421 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4422 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4423
4424 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4425 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4426 recognized by this target hook.
4427
4428 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4429 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4430 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4431
4432 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4433 @end deftypefn
4434
4435 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4436 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4437 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4438 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4439 @end defmac
4440
4441 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4442 Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4443 is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4444 arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4445 pointer return value. Define this to true if that behavior is
4446 undesirable on your target.
4447 @end deftypevr
4448
4449 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4450 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4451 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4452 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4453 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4454
4455 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4456 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4457 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4458 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4459 @code{SImode} rtx.
4460 @end deftypefn
4461
4462 @node Aggregate Return
4463 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4464 @cindex aggregates as return values
4465 @cindex large return values
4466 @cindex returning aggregate values
4467 @cindex structure value address
4468
4469 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4470 cases), the value is not returned according to
4471 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4472 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4473 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4474 address}.
4475
4476 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4477 memory.
4478
4479 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4480 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4481 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4482 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4483 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4484 libcalls.
4485
4486 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4487 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4488 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4489 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4490 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4491 values, and 0 otherwise.
4492
4493 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4494 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4495 to indicate this.
4496 @end deftypefn
4497
4498 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4499 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4500 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4501 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4502 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4503 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4504 target hook.
4505
4506 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4507 @end defmac
4508
4509 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4510 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4511 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4512 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4513 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4514 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4515 argument.
4516
4517 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4518 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4519 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4520 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4521 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4522 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4523 the caller.
4524
4525 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4526 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4527 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4528 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4529 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4530 @end deftypefn
4531
4532 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4533 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4534 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4535 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4536
4537 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4538 pass an address to the subroutine.
4539
4540 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4541 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4542 @end defmac
4543
4544 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4545 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4546 @end deftypefn
4547
4548 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4549 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4550 @end deftypefn
4551
4552 @node Caller Saves
4553 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4554
4555 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4556 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4557 must live across calls.
4558
4559 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4560 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4561 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4562 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4563 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4564 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4565 @end defmac
4566
4567 @node Function Entry
4568 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4569 @cindex function entry and exit
4570 @cindex prologue
4571 @cindex epilogue
4572
4573 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4574 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4575
4576 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4577 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4578 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4579 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4580 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4581 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4582 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4583
4584 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4585 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4586
4587 @findex regs_ever_live
4588 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4589 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4590 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4591 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4592 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4593 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4594
4595 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4596 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4597 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4598 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4599 registers are used in the function.
4600
4601 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4602 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4603 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4604 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4605 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4606 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4607 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4608
4609 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4610 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4611 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4612 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4613 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4614 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4615 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4616 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4617 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4618 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4619 @end deftypefn
4620
4621 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4622 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4623 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4624 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4625 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4626 @end deftypefn
4627
4628 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4629 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4630 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4631 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4632 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4633 @end deftypefn
4634
4635 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4636 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4637 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4638 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4639 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4640 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4641 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4642 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4643
4644 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4645 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4646 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4647 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4648
4649 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4650 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4651 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4652 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4653 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4654 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4655
4656 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4657 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4658 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4659 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4660 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4661 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4662
4663 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4664 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4665 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4666 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4667
4668 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4669 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4670 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4671 number of arguments.
4672
4673 @findex pops_args
4674 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4675 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4676 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4677 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4678 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4679 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4680 @end deftypefn
4681
4682 @itemize @bullet
4683 @item
4684 @findex pretend_args_size
4685 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4686 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4687 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4688 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4689 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4690 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4691 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4692 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4693 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4694 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4695
4696 @item
4697 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4698 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4699 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4700 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4701 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4702 a save area.
4703
4704 @item
4705 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4706 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4707 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4708 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4709
4710 @item
4711 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4712 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4713 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4714 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4715 @end itemize
4716
4717 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4718 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4719 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4720 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4721 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4722 default is 0.
4723
4724 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4725 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4726 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4727 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4728 @end defmac
4729
4730 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4731 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4732 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4733 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4734 @end defmac
4735
4736 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4737 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4738 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4739 on entry to an exception edge.
4740 @end defmac
4741
4742 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4743 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4744 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4745 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4746 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4747 the real function.
4748
4749 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4750 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4751 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4752 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4753 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4754 all other incoming arguments.
4755
4756 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4757 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4758 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4759
4760 @smallexample
4761 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4762 @end smallexample
4763
4764 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4765 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4766 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4767 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4768
4769 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4770 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4771 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4772 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4773
4774 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4775 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4776 some targets, but probably not.
4777
4778 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4779 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4780 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4781 not support varargs.
4782 @end deftypefn
4783
4784 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4785 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4786 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4787 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4788 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4789 previously exposed.
4790 @end deftypefn
4791
4792 @node Profiling
4793 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4794 @cindex profiling, code generation
4795
4796 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4797
4798 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4799 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4800 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4801
4802 @findex mcount
4803 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4804 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4805 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4806 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4807
4808 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4809 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4810 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4811 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4812 @end defmac
4813
4814 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4815 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4816 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4817 not support profiling.
4818 @end defmac
4819
4820 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4821 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4822 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4823 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4824 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4825 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4826 @end defmac
4827
4828 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4829 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4830 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4831 @end defmac
4832
4833 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4834 This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4835 @end deftypefn
4836
4837 @node Tail Calls
4838 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4839 @cindex tail calls
4840
4841 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4842 True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4843 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4844 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4845
4846 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4847 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4848 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4849 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4850 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4851 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4852 @end deftypefn
4853
4854 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4855 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4856 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4857 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4858 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4859 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4860 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4861 @end deftypefn
4862
4863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4864 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4865 @end deftypefn
4866
4867 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4868 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4869 @end deftypefn
4870
4871 @node Shrink-wrapping separate components
4872 @subsection Shrink-wrapping separate components
4873 @cindex shrink-wrapping separate components
4874
4875 The prologue may perform a variety of target dependent tasks such as
4876 saving callee-saved registers, saving the return address, aligning the
4877 stack, creating a stack frame, initializing the PIC register, setting
4878 up the static chain, etc.
4879
4880 On some targets some of these tasks may be independent of others and
4881 thus may be shrink-wrapped separately. These independent tasks are
4882 referred to as components and are handled generically by the target
4883 independent parts of GCC.
4884
4885 Using the following hooks those prologue or epilogue components can be
4886 shrink-wrapped separately, so that the initialization (and possibly
4887 teardown) those components do is not done as frequently on execution
4888 paths where this would unnecessary.
4889
4890 What exactly those components are is up to the target code; the generic
4891 code treats them abstractly, as a bit in an @code{sbitmap}. These
4892 @code{sbitmap}s are allocated by the @code{shrink_wrap.get_separate_components}
4893 and @code{shrink_wrap.components_for_bb} hooks, and deallocated by the
4894 generic code.
4895
4896 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_GET_SEPARATE_COMPONENTS (void)
4897 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
4898 components that can be separately shrink-wrapped in the current function.
4899 Return @code{NULL} if the current function should not get any separate
4900 shrink-wrapping.
4901 Don't define this hook if it would always return @code{NULL}.
4902 If it is defined, the other hooks in this group have to be defined as well.
4903 @end deftypefn
4904
4905 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_COMPONENTS_FOR_BB (basic_block)
4906 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
4907 components where either the prologue component has to be executed before
4908 the @code{basic_block}, or the epilogue component after it, or both.
4909 @end deftypefn
4910
4911 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_DISQUALIFY_COMPONENTS (sbitmap @var{components}, edge @var{e}, sbitmap @var{edge_components}, bool @var{is_prologue})
4912 This hook should clear the bits in the @var{components} bitmap for those
4913 components in @var{edge_components} that the target cannot handle on edge
4914 @var{e}, where @var{is_prologue} says if this is for a prologue or an
4915 epilogue instead.
4916 @end deftypefn
4917
4918 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_PROLOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4919 Emit prologue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
4920 @end deftypefn
4921
4922 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_EPILOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4923 Emit epilogue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
4924 @end deftypefn
4925
4926 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_SET_HANDLED_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4927 Mark the components in the parameter as handled, so that the
4928 @code{prologue} and @code{epilogue} named patterns know to ignore those
4929 components. The target code should not hang on to the @code{sbitmap}, it
4930 will be deleted after this call.
4931 @end deftypefn
4932
4933 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4934 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4935 @cindex stack smashing protection
4936
4937 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4938 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4939 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4940 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4941 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4942 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4943
4944 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4945 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4946 @end deftypefn
4947
4948 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4949 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
4950 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4951 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4952
4953 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4954 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4955 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4956 @end deftypefn
4957
4958 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_RUNTIME_ENABLED_P (void)
4959 Returns true if the target wants GCC's default stack protect runtime support, otherwise return false. The default implementation always returns true.
4960 @end deftypefn
4961
4962 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
4963 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
4964 @end deftypefn
4965
4966 @node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
4967 @subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
4968 @cindex miscellaneous register hooks
4969
4970 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
4971 Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
4972 clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
4973 That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
4974 linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
4975 modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
4976 in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
4977 The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
4978 is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
4979 @end deftypevr
4980
4981 @node Varargs
4982 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4983 @cindex varargs implementation
4984
4985 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4986 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4987 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4988 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4989 conditionals to include it.
4990
4991 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4992 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4993 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4994 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4995 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4996 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4997
4998 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4999 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5000 below.
5001
5002 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5003 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5004 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5005 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5006 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5007
5008 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5009 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5010 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5011 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5012
5013 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5014 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5015 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5016 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5017 to use them for its own purposes.
5018 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5019 @c 10feb93
5020 @end defmac
5021
5022 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5023 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5024 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5025 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5026 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5027 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5028 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5029 of the current function.
5030 @end defmac
5031
5032 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5033 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5034 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5035 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5036 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5037 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5038
5039 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5040 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5041 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5042
5043 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5044 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5045 @end defmac
5046
5047 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5048
5049 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5050 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5051 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5052 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5053 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5054 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5055 @end deftypefn
5056
5057 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5058 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5059 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5060 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5061 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5062 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5063 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5064 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5065
5066 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5067 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5068 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5069 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5070
5071 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5072 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5073 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5074 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5075 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5076 frame.
5077
5078 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5079 compile time without knowing their data types,
5080 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5081 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5082 for all data types.
5083
5084 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5085 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5086 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5087 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5088 not generate any instructions in this case.
5089 @end deftypefn
5090
5091 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5092 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5093 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5094
5095 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5096 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5097 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5098 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5099 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5100 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5101 except the last are treated as named.
5102
5103 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5104 @end deftypefn
5105
5106 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5107 While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5108 for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5109 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5110 before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5111 function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5112 @code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5113 invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5114 This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5115 registers if a target needs it.
5116 For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5117 passed instead of an argument register.
5118 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5119 @end deftypefn
5120
5121 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5122 This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5123 just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5124 signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5125 emitted call are now no longer in use.
5126 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5127 @end deftypefn
5128
5129 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5130 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5131 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5132 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5133 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5134 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5135 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5136 @end deftypefn
5137
5138 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5139 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5140 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5141 bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5142 memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5143 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5144 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5145 should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5146 @end deftypefn
5147
5148 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5149 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5150 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5151 @var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5152 memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5153 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5154 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5155 should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5156 @end deftypefn
5157
5158 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5159 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5160 returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5161 loaded bounds.
5162 @end deftypefn
5163
5164 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5165 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5166 returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5167 @end deftypefn
5168
5169 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_CHKP_FUNCTION_VALUE_BOUNDS (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
5170 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
5171 returns bounds for returned pointers. Arguments meaning is similar to
5172 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}.
5173 @end deftypefn
5174
5175 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5176 Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored
5177 into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to
5178 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.
5179 @end deftypefn
5180
5181 @node Trampolines
5182 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5183 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5184 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5185
5186 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5187 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5188 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5189 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5190 trampoline.
5191
5192 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5193 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5194 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5195 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5196 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5197 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5198 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5199 operands.
5200
5201 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5202 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5203 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5204 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5205 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5206 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5207 separately.
5208
5209 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5210 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5211 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5212 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5213 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5214
5215 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5216 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5217 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5218 to generate it on the spot.
5219 @end deftypefn
5220
5221 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5222 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5223 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5224 @end defmac
5225
5226 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5227 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5228 @end defmac
5229
5230 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5231 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5232
5233 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5234 is used for aligning trampolines.
5235 @end defmac
5236
5237 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5238 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5239 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5240 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5241 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5242 when it is called.
5243
5244 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5245 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5246 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5247 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5248 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5249 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5250
5251 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5252 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5253 initializing the trampoline proper.
5254 @end deftypefn
5255
5256 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5257 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5258 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5259 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5260 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5261 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5262 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5263 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5264 @end deftypefn
5265
5266 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_CUSTOM_FUNCTION_DESCRIPTORS
5267 This hook should be defined to a power of 2 if the target will benefit
5268 from the use of custom descriptors for nested functions instead of the
5269 standard trampolines. Such descriptors are created at run time on the
5270 stack and made up of data only, but they are non-standard so the generated
5271 code must be prepared to deal with them. This hook should be defined to 0
5272 if the target uses function descriptors for its standard calling sequence,
5273 like for example HP-PA or IA-64. Using descriptors for nested functions
5274 eliminates the need for trampolines that reside on the stack and require
5275 it to be made executable.
5276
5277 The value of the macro is used to parameterize the run-time identification
5278 scheme implemented to distinguish descriptors from function addresses: it
5279 gives the number of bytes by which their address is misaligned compared
5280 with function addresses. The value of 1 will generally work, unless it is
5281 already reserved by the target for another purpose, like for example on ARM.
5282 @end deftypevr
5283
5284 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5285 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5286 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5287 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5288
5289 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5290 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5291 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5292 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5293 latter makes initialization faster.
5294
5295 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5296 the following macro.
5297
5298 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5299 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5300 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5301 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5302 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5303 @end defmac
5304
5305 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5306 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5307 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5308 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5309 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5310
5311 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5312 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5313 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5314 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5315 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5316
5317 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5318 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5319 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5320 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5321 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5322 special assembler code.
5323 @end defmac
5324
5325 @node Library Calls
5326 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5327 @cindex library subroutine names
5328 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5329
5330 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5331 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5332
5333 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5334 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5335 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5336 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5337 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5338 @end defmac
5339
5340 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5341 @findex init_one_libfunc
5342 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5343 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5344 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5345 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5346 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5347 library routines.
5348
5349 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5350 @end deftypefn
5351
5352 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5353 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5354 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5355 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5356 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5357 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5358 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5359 @end deftypevr
5360
5361 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5362 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5363 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5364 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5365 return a tristate.
5366
5367 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5368 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5369 don't need to define this macro.
5370 @end defmac
5371
5372 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5373 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5374 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5375 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5376 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5377 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5378 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5379 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5380 @end defmac
5381
5382 @defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5383 This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5384 instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5385 make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5386 division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5387 make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5388 @end defmac
5389
5390 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5391 @findex matherr
5392 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5393 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5394 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5395 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5396 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5397 system.
5398
5399 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5400 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5401 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5402 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5403 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5404 @end defmac
5405
5406 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5407 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5408 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5409 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5410 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5411 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5412 @end defmac
5413
5414 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5415 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5416 @var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5417 @end deftypefn
5418
5419 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5420 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5421 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5422 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5423 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5424 the NeXT runtime installed.
5425
5426 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5427 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5428 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5429
5430 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5431 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5432 @end defmac
5433
5434 @node Addressing Modes
5435 @section Addressing Modes
5436 @cindex addressing modes
5437
5438 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5439 This is about addressing modes.
5440
5441 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5442 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5443 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5444 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5445 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5446 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5447 @end defmac
5448
5449 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5450 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5451 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5452 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5453 the size of the memory operand.
5454 @end defmac
5455
5456 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5457 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5458 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5459 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5460 @end defmac
5461
5462 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5463 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5464 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5465 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5466 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5467 constant addresses are supported.
5468 @end defmac
5469
5470 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5471 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5472 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5473 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5474 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5475 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5476 @end defmac
5477
5478 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5479 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5480 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5481 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5482 accept.
5483 @end defmac
5484
5485 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5486 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5487 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5488
5489 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5490 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5491 desired by the caller.
5492
5493 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5494 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5495 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5496 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5497 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5498 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5499 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5500 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5501
5502 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5503 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5504 register is required.
5505
5506 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5507 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5508 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5509 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5510 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5511
5512 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5513 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5514 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5515 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5516 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5517
5518 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5519 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5520 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5521 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5522 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5523 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5524 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5525 Format}.
5526
5527 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5528 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5529 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5530 has this syntax:
5531
5532 @example
5533 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5534 @end example
5535
5536 @noindent
5537 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5538 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5539
5540 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5541 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5542 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5543 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5544 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5545
5546 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5547 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5548 @end deftypefn
5549
5550 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5551 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5552 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5553 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5554 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5555 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5556 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5557 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5558 @code{'m'} constraint.
5559 @end defmac
5560
5561 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5562 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5563 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5564 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5565 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5566
5567 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5568 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5569
5570 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5571 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5572 @end defmac
5573
5574 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
5575 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5576 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5577 address.
5578
5579 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5580 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5581 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5582 @var{x}.
5583
5584 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5585 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5586 should return the new @var{x}.
5587
5588 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5589 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5590 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5591 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5592 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5593 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5594 strategy can generate better code.
5595 @end deftypefn
5596
5597 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5598 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5599 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5600 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5601 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5602 performance reasons.
5603
5604 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5605 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5606 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5607 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5608 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5609 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5610 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5611 be shared.
5612
5613 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5614 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5615 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5616 of reload internals.
5617
5618 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5619 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5620 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5621
5622 @findex push_reload
5623 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5624 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5625 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5626
5627 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5628 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5629 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5630 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5631 @code{push_reload}.
5632
5633 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5634 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5635 the address has become legitimate.
5636
5637 @findex copy_rtx
5638 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5639 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5640 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5641 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5642 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5643 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5644 @end defmac
5645
5646 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5647 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5648 space @var{addrspace} can have
5649 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5650 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5651 but not others.
5652
5653 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5654 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5655 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5656 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5657
5658 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5659
5660 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5661 @end deftypefn
5662
5663 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5664 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5665 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5666 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5667
5668 The default definition returns true.
5669 @end deftypefn
5670
5671 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5672 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5673 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5674 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5675 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5676 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5677 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5678 into their original form.
5679 @end deftypefn
5680
5681 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5682 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5683 debug sections.
5684 @end deftypefn
5685
5686 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5687 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5688 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5689 of @var{x}.
5690
5691 The default version of this hook returns false.
5692
5693 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5694 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5695 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5696 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5697 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5698 @end deftypefn
5699
5700 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5701 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5702 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5703 of @var{x}.
5704
5705 The default version returns false for all constants.
5706 @end deftypefn
5707
5708 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5709 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5710 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5711
5712 The default version returns true for all decls.
5713 @end deftypefn
5714
5715 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (tree @var{fndecl})
5716 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the
5717 reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or
5718 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5719 @end deftypefn
5720
5721 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5722 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5723 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5724 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5725 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5726
5727 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5728 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5729 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5730 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5731 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5732 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5733 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5734 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5735 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5736 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5737 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5738
5739 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5740 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5741 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5742 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5743 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5744 described above.
5745 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5746 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5747 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5748 @end deftypefn
5749
5750 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5751 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5752 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5753 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5754 @end deftypefn
5755
5756 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5757 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given scalar type @var{type}. @var{is_packed} is false if the scalar access using @var{type} is known to be naturally aligned.
5758 @end deftypefn
5759
5760 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (machine_mode, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5761 Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5762 @end deftypefn
5763
5764 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5765 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5766 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5767 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5768 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5769 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5770
5771 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5772 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5773 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5774 @end deftypefn
5775
5776 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5777 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5778 vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code
5779 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5780 The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5781 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5782 @end deftypefn
5783
5784 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MD_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5785 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5786 vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}. The
5787 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5788 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5789 @end deftypefn
5790
5791 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5792 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5793 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5794 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5795 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5796 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5797 @end deftypefn
5798
5799 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
5800 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5801 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5802 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5803 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5804 @end deftypefn
5805
5806 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5807 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5808 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5809 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5810 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5811 @end deftypefn
5812
5813 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (unsigned @var{nunits}, unsigned @var{length})
5814 This hook returns mode to be used for a mask to be used for a vector
5815 of specified @var{length} with @var{nunits} elements. By default an integer
5816 vector mode of a proper size is returned.
5817 @end deftypefn
5818
5819 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5820 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5821 @end deftypefn
5822
5823 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5824 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5825 @end deftypefn
5826
5827 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5828 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5829 @end deftypefn
5830
5831 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5832 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5833 @end deftypefn
5834
5835 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5836 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5837 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5838 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5839 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5840 loads.
5841 @end deftypefn
5842
5843 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5844 Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype}
5845 is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5846 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5847 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter
5848 stores.
5849 @end deftypefn
5850
5851 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
5852 This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
5853 fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
5854 @var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
5855 The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
5856 or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
5857 @end deftypefn
5858
5859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5860 This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
5861 to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
5862 @end deftypefn
5863
5864 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5865 This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
5866 in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
5867 usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
5868 to use it.
5869 @end deftypefn
5870
5871 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMT_VF (void)
5872 Return number of threads in SIMT thread group on the target.
5873 @end deftypefn
5874
5875 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level})
5876 This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC
5877 compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1
5878 and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the
5879 function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine is is the
5880 outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. The hook
5881 should verify non-default values. If DECL is NULL, global defaults
5882 are being validated and unspecified defaults should be filled in.
5883 Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return
5884 true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to
5885 provide dimensions larger than 1.
5886 @end deftypefn
5887
5888 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis})
5889 This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,
5890 or zero if unbounded.
5891 @end deftypefn
5892
5893 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork})
5894 This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN
5895 function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they
5896 should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.
5897 It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should
5898 return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific
5899 gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).
5900 The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.
5901 @end deftypefn
5902
5903 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call})
5904 This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the
5905 @var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple
5906 instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to
5907 the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the
5908 expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible
5909 for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.
5910 @end deftypefn
5911
5912 @node Anchored Addresses
5913 @section Anchored Addresses
5914 @cindex anchored addresses
5915 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5916
5917 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5918 For example, if we have:
5919
5920 @smallexample
5921 static int a, b, c;
5922 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5923 @end smallexample
5924
5925 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5926 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5927 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5928 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5929 be something like:
5930
5931 @smallexample
5932 int foo (void)
5933 @{
5934 register int *xr = &x;
5935 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5936 @}
5937 @end smallexample
5938
5939 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5940 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5941
5942 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5943 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5944 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5945 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5946
5947 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5948 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5949 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5950 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5951 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5952 @end deftypevr
5953
5954 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5955 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5956 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5957 value is 0.
5958 @end deftypevr
5959
5960 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5961 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5962 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5963 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5964 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5965
5966 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5967 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5968 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5969 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5970 @end deftypefn
5971
5972 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5973 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5974 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5975 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5976
5977 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5978 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5979 or target-specific sections.
5980 @end deftypefn
5981
5982 @node Condition Code
5983 @section Condition Code Status
5984 @cindex condition code status
5985
5986 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5987 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5988
5989 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5990 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5991 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5992 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5993 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5994 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5995 most RISC machines.
5996
5997 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5998 the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
5999 and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
6000 arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
6001 Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
6002 the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
6003
6004 These restrictions can prevent important
6005 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
6006 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
6007 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
6008 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
6009 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
6010
6011 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
6012 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
6013 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
6014 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
6015 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
6016 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
6017 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
6018
6019 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
6020 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
6021 interested in most macros in this section.
6022
6023 @menu
6024 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
6025 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
6026 @end menu
6027
6028 @node CC0 Condition Codes
6029 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
6030 @findex cc0
6031
6032 @findex cc_status
6033 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
6034 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
6035 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
6036 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
6037 currently based, and several standard flags.
6038
6039 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
6040 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
6041 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
6042
6043 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
6044 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
6045 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
6046
6047 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6048 @end defmac
6049
6050 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
6051 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
6052 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
6053 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
6054 define this macro to initialize it.
6055
6056 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6057 @end defmac
6058
6059 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
6060 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
6061 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
6062 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
6063 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
6064 set @code{(cc0)}.
6065
6066 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6067
6068 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
6069 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
6070 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
6071 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
6072 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
6073 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
6074 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
6075 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
6076 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
6077 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
6078 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
6079 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
6080 condition code value.
6081
6082 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
6083 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
6084 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
6085 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
6086 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
6087 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
6088 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
6089
6090 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
6091 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
6092 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
6093 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
6094 @end defmac
6095
6096 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
6097 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
6098 @findex CCmode
6099 @findex MODE_CC
6100
6101 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
6102 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
6103 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6104 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
6105 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6106 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6107 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6108 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6109 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6110 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6111 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6112
6113 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6114 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6115 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6116 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6117 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6118 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6119 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6120
6121 @smallexample
6122 (define_insn ""
6123 [(set (reg:CCNZ 0)
6124 (compare:CCNZ
6125 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6126 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6127 (const_int 0)))]
6128 ""
6129 "@dots{}")
6130 @end smallexample
6131
6132 @noindent
6133 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CCNZmode}
6134 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6135
6136 @smallexample
6137 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6138 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6139 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
6140 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
6141 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6142 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
6143 ? CCNZmode : CCmode))
6144 @end smallexample
6145
6146 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6147 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6148 this section.
6149
6150 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6151 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6152 @end defmac
6153
6154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
6155 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6156 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6157 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6158 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6159
6160 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6161 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6162 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6163 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6164 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6165 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6166 allowed to swap operands in that case.
6167
6168 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6169 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6170 @file{md} file.
6171
6172 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6173 comparison code or operands.
6174 @end deftypefn
6175
6176 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6177 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6178 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6179 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6180 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6181
6182 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6183 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6184 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6185 inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
6186
6187 @smallexample
6188 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6189 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
6190 @end smallexample
6191 @end defmac
6192
6193 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6194 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6195 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6196 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6197 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6198 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6199 freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
6200 like:
6201
6202 @smallexample
6203 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6204 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6205 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6206 @end smallexample
6207 @end defmac
6208
6209 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6210 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6211 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6212 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6213 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6214 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6215 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6216 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6217 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6218 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6219 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6220
6221 The default version of this hook returns false.
6222 @end deftypefn
6223
6224 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
6225 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6226 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6227 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6228 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6229 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6230 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6231
6232 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6233 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6234 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6235 @end deftypefn
6236
6237 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6238 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
6239 @end deftypevr
6240
6241 @node Costs
6242 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6243 @cindex costs of instructions
6244 @cindex relative costs
6245 @cindex speed of instructions
6246
6247 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6248 on the target machine.
6249
6250 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6251 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6252 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6253 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6254 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6255 that.
6256
6257 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6258 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6259 registers if they are not general registers.
6260
6261 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6262 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6263 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6264 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6265 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6266 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6267
6268 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6269 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6270 @end defmac
6271
6272 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6273 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6274 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6275 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6276 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6277 that.
6278
6279 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6280 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6281 registers if they are not general registers.
6282
6283 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6284 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6285 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6286 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6287 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6288 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6289
6290 The default version of this function returns 2.
6291 @end deftypefn
6292
6293 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6294 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6295 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6296 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6297 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6298 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6299 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6300
6301 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6302 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6303 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6304 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6305 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6306 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6307
6308 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6309 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6310 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6311 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6312 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6313 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6314 are the same as to this macro.
6315
6316 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6317 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6318 @end defmac
6319
6320 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6321 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6322 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6323 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6324 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6325 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6326 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6327
6328 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6329 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6330 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6331 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6332 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6333 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6334
6335 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6336 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6337 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6338 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6339 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6340 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6341 are the same as to this target hook.
6342 @end deftypefn
6343
6344 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6345 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6346 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6347 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6348 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6349 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6350 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6351 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6352 @end defmac
6353
6354 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6355 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6356 ordinarily expect.
6357
6358 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6359 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6360 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6361 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6362 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6363 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6364
6365 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6366 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6367 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6368 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6369 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6370 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6371 @end defmac
6372
6373 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6374 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6375 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6376 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6377 handler. This macro is invoked only for unaligned accesses, i.e. when
6378 @code{@var{alignment} < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.
6379
6380 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6381 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6382 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6383 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6384 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6385
6386 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6387 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6388 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6389 @end defmac
6390
6391 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6392 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6393 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6394 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6395 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6396
6397 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6398 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6399 the number of such sequences.
6400
6401 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6402 optimized for speed rather than size.
6403
6404 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6405 @end defmac
6406
6407 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
6408 GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6409 two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6410 when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6411 implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6412 insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6413 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6414 unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6415
6416 This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6417 given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6418 infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6419 Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6420 units.
6421
6422 The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6423 @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES} or
6424 @code{COMPARE_BY_PIECES}. These describe the type of memory operation
6425 under consideration.
6426
6427 The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6428 optimized for speed rather than size.
6429
6430 Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6431 for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6432 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or
6433 @code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6434 insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6435 the body of the memory operation.
6436
6437 Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6438 in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6439 move would be greater than that of a library call.
6440 @end deftypefn
6441
6442 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_BY_PIECES_BRANCH_RATIO (machine_mode @var{mode})
6443 When expanding a block comparison in MODE, gcc can try to reduce the
6444 number of branches at the expense of more memory operations. This hook
6445 allows the target to override the default choice. It should return the
6446 factor by which branches should be reduced over the plain expansion with
6447 one comparison per @var{mode}-sized piece. A port can also prevent a
6448 particular mode from being used for block comparisons by returning a
6449 negative number from this hook.
6450 @end deftypefn
6451
6452 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6453 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6454 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6455 @end defmac
6456
6457 @defmac STORE_MAX_PIECES
6458 A C expression used by @code{store_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6459 a store used to memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}, or two times
6460 the size of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, whichever is smaller.
6461 @end defmac
6462
6463 @defmac COMPARE_MAX_PIECES
6464 A C expression used by @code{compare_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6465 a load or store used to compare memory is. Defaults to
6466 @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}.
6467 @end defmac
6468
6469 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6470 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6471 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6472 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6473 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6474
6475 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6476 optimized for speed rather than size.
6477
6478 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6479 @end defmac
6480
6481 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6482 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6483 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6484 a block set insn or a library call.
6485 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6486 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6487
6488 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6489 optimized for speed rather than size.
6490
6491 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6492 @end defmac
6493
6494 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6495 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6496 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6497 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6498 @end defmac
6499
6500 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6501 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6502 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6503 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6504 @end defmac
6505
6506 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6507 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6508 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6509 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6510 @end defmac
6511
6512 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6513 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6514 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6515 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6516 @end defmac
6517
6518 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6519 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6520 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6521 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6522 @end defmac
6523
6524 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6525 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6526 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6527 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6528 @end defmac
6529
6530 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6531 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6532 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6533 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6534 @end defmac
6535
6536 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6537 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6538 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6539 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6540 @end defmac
6541
6542 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6543 Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
6544 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6545 @end defmac
6546
6547 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6548 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6549 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6550 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6551 @end defmac
6552
6553 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P (int @var{op}, machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}, optimization_type @var{opt_type})
6554 Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with
6555 modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}.
6556 The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction
6557 whose C condition is true. @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion
6558 optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}.
6559
6560 For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and
6561 @var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the
6562 optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}.
6563
6564 The default hook returns true for all inputs.
6565 @end deftypefn
6566
6567 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6568 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6569
6570 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6571 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6572 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6573 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6574 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6575 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6576 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6577
6578 @var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6579 do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
6580
6581 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6582 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6583 instructions.
6584
6585 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6586 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6587 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6588 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6589 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6590
6591 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6592 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6593 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6594
6595 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6596 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6597 @end deftypefn
6598
6599 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6600 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6601 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6602 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6603
6604 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6605 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6606 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6607 all addresses will have equal costs.
6608
6609 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6610 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6611 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6612
6613 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6614 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6615 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6616 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6617 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6618 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6619 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6620 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6621
6622 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6623
6624 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6625 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6626 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6627 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6628 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6629 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6630 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6631 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6632 @end deftypefn
6633
6634 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MAX_NOCE_IFCVT_SEQ_COST (edge @var{e})
6635 This hook returns a value in the same units as @code{TARGET_RTX_COSTS},
6636 giving the maximum acceptable cost for a sequence generated by the RTL
6637 if-conversion pass when conditional execution is not available.
6638 The RTL if-conversion pass attempts to convert conditional operations
6639 that would require a branch to a series of unconditional operations and
6640 @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns. This hook returns the maximum cost of the
6641 unconditional instructions and the @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns.
6642 RTL if-conversion is cancelled if the cost of the converted sequence
6643 is greater than the value returned by this hook.
6644
6645 @code{e} is the edge between the basic block containing the conditional
6646 branch to the basic block which would be executed if the condition
6647 were true.
6648
6649 The default implementation of this hook uses the
6650 @code{max-rtl-if-conversion-[un]predictable} parameters if they are set,
6651 and uses a multiple of @code{BRANCH_COST} otherwise.
6652 @end deftypefn
6653
6654 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NOCE_CONVERSION_PROFITABLE_P (rtx_insn *@var{seq}, struct noce_if_info *@var{if_info})
6655 This hook returns true if the instruction sequence @code{seq} is a good
6656 candidate as a replacement for the if-convertible sequence described in
6657 @code{if_info}.
6658 @end deftypefn
6659
6660 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void)
6661 This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow
6662 speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets
6663 such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without
6664 delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,
6665 disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of
6666 delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable
6667 as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.
6668 @end deftypefn
6669
6670 @node Scheduling
6671 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6672
6673 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6674 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6675 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6676 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6677
6678 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6679 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6680 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6681 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6682 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6683 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6684 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6685 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6686 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6687 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6688 @end deftypefn
6689
6690 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
6691 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6692 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6693 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6694 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6695 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6696 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6697 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6698 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6699 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6700 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6701 was scheduled.
6702 @end deftypefn
6703
6704 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{dep_type1}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost}, unsigned int @var{dw})
6705 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6706 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through a
6707 dependence of type dep_type, and strength @var{dw}. It should return the new
6708 value. The default is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be
6709 used for example to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline
6710 description that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost
6711 as a data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6712 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6713 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6714 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6715 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6716 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6717 @end deftypefn
6718
6719 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6720 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6721 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6722 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6723 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6724 scheduling priorities of insns.
6725 @end deftypefn
6726
6727 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6728 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6729 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6730 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6731 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6732 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6733 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6734 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6735 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6736 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6737 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6738 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6739 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6740 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6741 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6742 @end deftypefn
6743
6744 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6745 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6746 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6747 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6748 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6749 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6750 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6751 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6752 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6753 @end deftypefn
6754
6755 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
6756 This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
6757 @end deftypefn
6758
6759 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
6760 This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
6761 a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
6762 (@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
6763 group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
6764 two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
6765 validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
6766 @end deftypefn
6767
6768 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
6769 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6770 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6771 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6772 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6773 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6774 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6775 calculated.
6776 @end deftypefn
6777
6778 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6779 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6780 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6781 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6782 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6783 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6784 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6785 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6786 @end deftypefn
6787
6788 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6789 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6790 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6791 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6792 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6793 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6794 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6795 @end deftypefn
6796
6797 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6798 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6799 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6800 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6801 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6802 @end deftypefn
6803
6804 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6805 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6806 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6807 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6808 @end deftypefn
6809
6810 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6811 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6812 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6813 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6814 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6815 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6816 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6817 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6818 @end deftypefn
6819
6820 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6821 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6822 @end deftypefn
6823
6824 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6825 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6826 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6827 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6828 @end deftypefn
6829
6830 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6831 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6832 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6833 @end deftypefn
6834
6835 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6836 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6837 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6838 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6839 state on a single insn is not enough.
6840 @end deftypefn
6841
6842 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6843 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6844 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6845 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6846 state on a single insn is not enough.
6847 @end deftypefn
6848
6849 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6850 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6851 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6852 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6853 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6854 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6855 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6856 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6857 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6858 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6859 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6860
6861 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6862 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6863 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6864 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6865 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6866 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6867 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6868 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6869 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6870
6871 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6872 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6873 schedules to choose the best one.
6874
6875 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6876 @end deftypefn
6877
6878 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
6879
6880 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6881 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6882 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
6883 Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
6884 the current round of multipass scheduling.
6885 Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
6886 number of cycles.
6887 Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
6888 instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
6889 to allow backends make correct judgements.
6890
6891 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6892 @end deftypefn
6893
6894 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6895 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6896 scheduling.
6897 @end deftypefn
6898
6899 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6900 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6901 @end deftypefn
6902
6903 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6904 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6905 an instruction.
6906 @end deftypefn
6907
6908 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6909 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6910 round of multipass scheduling.
6911 @end deftypefn
6912
6913 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6914 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6915 @end deftypefn
6916
6917 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6918 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6919 @end deftypefn
6920
6921 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6922 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6923 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6924 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6925 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6926 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6927 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6928 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6929 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6930 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6931 and the current processor cycle.
6932 @end deftypefn
6933
6934 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6935 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6936 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6937 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6938 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6939 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6940 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6941 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6942 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6943 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6944 and @code{false} otherwise.
6945
6946 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6947 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6948 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6949 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6950 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6951 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6952 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6953 @end deftypefn
6954
6955 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6956 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6957 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6958 per instruction data structures.
6959 @end deftypefn
6960
6961 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6962 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6963 @end deftypefn
6964
6965 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6966 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6967 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6968 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6969 @end deftypefn
6970
6971 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6972 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6973 @end deftypefn
6974
6975 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6976 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6977 @end deftypefn
6978
6979 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6980 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6981 @end deftypefn
6982
6983 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6984 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6985 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6986 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6987 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6988 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6989 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6990 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6991 the generated speculative pattern.
6992 @end deftypefn
6993
6994 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
6995 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6996 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6997 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6998 @end deftypefn
6999
7000 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
7001 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
7002 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
7003 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
7004 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
7005 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
7006 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
7007 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
7008 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
7009 @end deftypefn
7010
7011 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
7012 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
7013 enabled/used.
7014 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
7015 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
7016 @end deftypefn
7017
7018 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_CAN_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
7019 Some instructions should never be speculated by the schedulers, usually
7020 because the instruction is too expensive to get this wrong. Often such
7021 instructions have long latency, and often they are not fully modeled in the
7022 pipeline descriptions. This hook should return @code{false} if @var{insn}
7023 should not be speculated.
7024 @end deftypefn
7025
7026 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
7027 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
7028 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
7029 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
7030 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
7031 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
7032 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
7033 @end deftypefn
7034
7035 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7036 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
7037 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
7038 @end deftypefn
7039
7040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7041 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
7042 in its second parameter.
7043 @end deftypefn
7044
7045 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
7046 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
7047 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
7048 also the latencies of operations.
7049 @end deftypevr
7050
7051 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
7052 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
7053 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
7054 @end deftypefn
7055
7056 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
7057 This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
7058 priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
7059 are returned via pointer parameters.
7060
7061 @var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
7062 @var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
7063 @var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
7064 fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
7065 @var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
7066 should be calculated and returned.
7067
7068 Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
7069 be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
7070 instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
7071 sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
7072 scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
7073 should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
7074 false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
7075 scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
7076 instructions.
7077
7078 Given below example:
7079
7080 @smallexample
7081 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7082 add r4, r4, r10
7083 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7084 sub r5, r5, r15
7085 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7086 add r4, r4, r11
7087 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7088 sub r5, r5, r16
7089 @end smallexample
7090
7091 On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
7092 merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
7093 loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
7094 this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
7095 instruction based on its fustion type, like:
7096
7097 @smallexample
7098 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
7099 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7100 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
7101 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7102 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
7103 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7104 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
7105 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7106 @end smallexample
7107
7108 Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
7109 to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
7110 pushed together in instruction flow, like:
7111
7112 @smallexample
7113 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7114 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7115 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7116 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7117 add r4, r4, r10
7118 sub r5, r5, r15
7119 add r4, r4, r11
7120 sub r5, r5, r16
7121 @end smallexample
7122
7123 Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
7124
7125 Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
7126 work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
7127
7128 This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
7129 the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
7130 @end deftypefn
7131
7132 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_DIVMOD_LIBFUNC (rtx @var{libfunc}, machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{op0}, rtx @var{op1}, rtx *@var{quot}, rtx *@var{rem})
7133 Define this hook for enabling divmod transform if the port does not have
7134 hardware divmod insn but defines target-specific divmod libfuncs.
7135 @end deftypefn
7136
7137 @node Sections
7138 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
7139 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
7140 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
7141
7142 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
7143 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
7144 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
7145 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
7146 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
7147 of sections.
7148
7149 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
7150 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
7151 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
7152 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
7153 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
7154 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
7155 They may however depend on command-line flags.
7156
7157 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
7158 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
7159 to be string literals.
7160
7161 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
7162 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
7163 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
7164 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
7165
7166 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
7167 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
7168 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
7169 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
7170 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
7171 reuse @code{text_section}.
7172
7173 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
7174 if the target does not provide them.
7175
7176 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7177 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7178 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
7179 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
7180 @end defmac
7181
7182 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7183 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
7184 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
7185 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7186 @end defmac
7187
7188 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7189 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
7190 executed functions in the program.
7191 @end defmac
7192
7193 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7194 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7195 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
7196 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
7197 @end defmac
7198
7199 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7200 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7201 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7202 initialized, writable small data.
7203 @end defmac
7204
7205 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7206 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7207 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
7208 data.
7209 @end defmac
7210
7211 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7212 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7213 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7214 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
7215 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
7216 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
7217 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
7218 used.
7219 @end defmac
7220
7221 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7222 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7223 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7224 uninitialized, writable small data.
7225 @end defmac
7226
7227 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
7228 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
7229 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
7230 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
7231 @end defmac
7232
7233 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7234 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7235 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
7236 default is @code{'T'}.
7237 @end defmac
7238
7239 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7240 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7241 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7242 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7243 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
7244 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7245 @end defmac
7246
7247 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
7248 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7249 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7250 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7251 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
7252 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7253 @end defmac
7254
7255 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7256 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7257 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7258 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7259 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7260 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7261 @end defmac
7262
7263 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7264 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7265 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7266 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7267 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7268 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7269 @end defmac
7270
7271 @defmac MACH_DEP_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7272 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7273 containing the flag used to mark a machine-dependent section. This
7274 corresponds to the @code{SECTION_MACH_DEP} section flag.
7275 @end defmac
7276
7277 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7278 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7279 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7280 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7281 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7282 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7283 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
7284 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7285 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7286 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7287 @end defmac
7288
7289 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7290 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7291 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7292 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7293 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7294 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7295 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7296 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7297 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7298 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7299 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7300 @end defmac
7301
7302 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7303 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7304 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7305 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7306 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7307 @end defmac
7308
7309 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7310 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7311 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7312 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7313 readonly data section is used.
7314
7315 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7316 @end defmac
7317
7318 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7319 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7320 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7321 of its own that you need to create.
7322
7323 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7324 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7325 described below.
7326 @end deftypefn
7327
7328 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7329 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7330 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7331 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7332 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7333
7334 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7335 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7336 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7337 in read-only sections even in executables.
7338 @end deftypefn
7339
7340 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7341 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7342 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7343 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7344 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7345 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7346 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7347
7348 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7349 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7350
7351 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7352 @end deftypefn
7353
7354 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7355 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7356 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7357
7358 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7359 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7360 it is unlikely to be called.
7361 @end defmac
7362
7363 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7364 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7365 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7366 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7367 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7368
7369 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7370 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7371 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7372 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7373 @end deftypefn
7374
7375 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7376 Return the readonly data section associated with
7377 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7378 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7379 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7380 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7381 otherwise.
7382 @end deftypefn
7383
7384 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7385 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7386 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7387 the string if a different section name should be used.
7388 @end deftypevr
7389
7390 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7391 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7392 @end deftypefn
7393
7394 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7395 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7396 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7397 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7398 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7399 in bits.
7400
7401 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7402 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7403 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7404 @end deftypefn
7405
7406 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7407 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7408 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7409 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7410 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7411 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7412 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7413 returns the @var{id} provided.
7414 @end deftypefn
7415
7416 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7417 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7418 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7419 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7420
7421 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7422 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7423 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7424 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7425 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7426
7427 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7428 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7429 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7430 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7431 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7432 leave it alone.)
7433
7434 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7435 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7436 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7437 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7438 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7439 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7440
7441 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7442 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7443 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7444 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7445 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7446 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7447
7448 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7449 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7450 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7451 before overriding it.
7452 @end deftypefn
7453
7454 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7455 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7456 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7457 may have added.
7458 @end deftypefn
7459
7460 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7461 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7462 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7463 @end deftypefn
7464
7465 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7466 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7467 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7468 @end deftypevr
7469
7470 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7471 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7472
7473 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7474 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7475 @end deftypefn
7476
7477 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7478 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7479 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7480 or executable image).
7481
7482 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7483 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7484 currently supported object file formats.
7485 @end deftypefn
7486
7487 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7488 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7489 The default value is false.
7490 @end deftypevr
7491
7492
7493 @node PIC
7494 @section Position Independent Code
7495 @cindex position independent code
7496 @cindex PIC
7497
7498 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7499 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7500 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7501 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7502 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7503 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7504 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7505 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7506 relative addresses.
7507 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7508 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7509
7510 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7511 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7512 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7513 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7514 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7515 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7516 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7517 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7518 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7519 @end defmac
7520
7521 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7522 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7523 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7524 the default is zero. Do not define
7525 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7526 @end defmac
7527
7528 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7529 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7530 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7531 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7532 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7533 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7534 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7535 position independent code.
7536 @end defmac
7537
7538 @node Assembler Format
7539 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7540
7541 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7542 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7543 instructions do.
7544
7545 @menu
7546 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7547 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7548 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7549 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7550 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7551 and termination routines.
7552 * Macros for Initialization::
7553 Specific macros that control the handling of
7554 initialization and termination routines.
7555 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7556 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7557 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7558 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7559 @end menu
7560
7561 @node File Framework
7562 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7563 @cindex assembler format
7564 @cindex output of assembler code
7565
7566 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7567 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7568
7569 @findex default_file_start
7570 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7571 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7572 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7573 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7574 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7575 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7576 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7577 @end deftypefn
7578
7579 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7580 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7581 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7582 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7583 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7584 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7585 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7586 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7587
7588 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7589 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7590 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7591 @end deftypevr
7592
7593 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7594 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7595 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7596 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7597 this to be done. The default is false.
7598 @end deftypevr
7599
7600 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7601 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7602 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7603 @end deftypefn
7604
7605 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7606 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7607 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7608 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7609 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7610 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7611 this function.
7612 @end deftypefun
7613
7614 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7615 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7616 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7617 nothing.
7618 @end deftypefn
7619
7620 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7621 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7622 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7623 nothing.
7624 @end deftypefn
7625
7626 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7627 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7628 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7629 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7630 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7631 nothing.
7632 @end deftypefn
7633
7634 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7635 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7636 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7637 the end of the line.
7638 @end defmac
7639
7640 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7641 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7642 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7643 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7644 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7645 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7646 @end defmac
7647
7648 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7649 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7650 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7651 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7652 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7653 @end defmac
7654
7655 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7656 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7657 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7658 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7659
7660 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7661 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7662 @end defmac
7663
7664 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7665 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7666
7667 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7668 @end deftypefn
7669
7670 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7671 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7672 @end deftypefn
7673
7674 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7675 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7676 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7677 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7678 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7679 of the filename using this macro.
7680 @end defmac
7681
7682 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7683 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7684 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7685 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7686 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7687 this section is associated.
7688 @end deftypefn
7689
7690 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_ELF_FLAGS_NUMERIC (unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int *@var{num})
7691 This hook can be used to encode ELF section flags for which no letter
7692 code has been defined in the assembler. It is called by
7693 @code{default_asm_named_section} whenever the section flags need to be
7694 emitted in the assembler output. If the hook returns true, then the
7695 numerical value for ELF section flags should be calculated from
7696 @var{flags} and saved in @var{*num}; the value is printed out instead of the
7697 normal sequence of letter codes. If the hook is not defined, or if it
7698 returns false, then @var{num} is ignored and the traditional letter sequence
7699 is emitted.
7700 @end deftypefn
7701
7702 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7703 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7704 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7705 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7706 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7707 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7708 (from static destructors).
7709 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7710 @end deftypefn
7711
7712 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7713 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7714 @end deftypefn
7715
7716 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7717 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7718 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7719 @end deftypevr
7720
7721 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7722 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7723 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7724 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7725 This is true on most ELF targets.
7726 @end deftypevr
7727
7728 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7729 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7730 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7731 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7732 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7733
7734 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7735 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7736 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7737 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7738 @end deftypefn
7739
7740 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7741 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7742 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7743 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7744 It can take the following values:
7745
7746 @table @gcctabopt
7747 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7748 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7749
7750 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7751 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7752 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7753 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7754 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7755 various different individual optimization passes.
7756
7757 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7758 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7759 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7760 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7761 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7762 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7763 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7764 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7765 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7766 switches.
7767
7768 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7769 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7770
7771 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7772 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7773 @end table
7774
7775 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7776 supported in the future.
7777
7778 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7779 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7780 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7781 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7782 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7783 hook.
7784 @end deftypefn
7785
7786 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7787 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7788 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7789 hook.
7790 @end deftypevr
7791
7792 @need 2000
7793 @node Data Output
7794 @subsection Output of Data
7795
7796
7797 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7798 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7799 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7800 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7801 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7802 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7803 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7804 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7805 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7806 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7807 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7808 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7809 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7810 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7811
7812 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7813 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7814 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7815 @end deftypevr
7816
7817 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7818 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7819 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7820 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7821 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7822 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7823 split the object into smaller parts.
7824
7825 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7826 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7827 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7828 @end deftypefn
7829
7830 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
7831 Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
7832 terminate an initialized variable declaration.
7833 @end deftypefn
7834
7835 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7836 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7837 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7838 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7839 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7840
7841 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7842 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7843 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7844 return @code{true}.
7845 @end deftypefn
7846
7847 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7848 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7849 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7850 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7851 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7852
7853 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7854 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7855 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7856 @end defmac
7857
7858 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7859 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7860 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7861 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7862 @end defmac
7863
7864 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7865 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7866 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7867 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7868 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7869 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7870 pool before the function.
7871 @end defmac
7872
7873 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7874 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7875 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7876 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7877 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7878 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7879 immediately after this call.
7880
7881 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7882 not be defined.
7883 @end defmac
7884
7885 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7886 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7887 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7888 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7889
7890 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7891 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7892 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7893 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7894 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7895 alignment.
7896
7897 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7898 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7899 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7900 Here is how to do this:
7901
7902 @smallexample
7903 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7904 @end smallexample
7905
7906 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7907 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7908 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7909
7910 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7911 @end defmac
7912
7913 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7914 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7915 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7916 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7917 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7918 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7919
7920 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7921 define this macro.
7922 @end defmac
7923
7924 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7925 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7926 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7927 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7928 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7929
7930 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7931 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7932 @end defmac
7933
7934 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7935 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7936 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7937 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7938 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7939 @end deftypevr
7940
7941 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7942 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7943
7944 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7945 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7946 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7947 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7948 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7949 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7950 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7951 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7952 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7953 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7954 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7955 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7956 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7957 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7958 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7959 on the host machine.
7960
7961 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7962 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7963 machine's memory.
7964 @end defmac
7965
7966 @node Uninitialized Data
7967 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7968
7969 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7970 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7971
7972 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7973 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7974 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7975 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7976 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7977 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7978 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7979 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7980 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7981 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7982 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7983 an ordinary undefined external.
7984
7985 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7986 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7987 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7988
7989 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7990 common global variables are output.
7991 @end defmac
7992
7993 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7994 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7995 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7996 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7997 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7998 as the number of bits.
7999 @end defmac
8000
8001 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8002 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
8003 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8004 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8005 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
8006 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
8007 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8008 @end defmac
8009
8010 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8011 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8012 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
8013 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
8014 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
8015
8016 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
8017 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
8018 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
8019 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
8020 the name, and a newline.
8021
8022 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
8023 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
8024 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
8025 You do not need to do both.
8026
8027 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
8028 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
8029 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
8030 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
8031 common in order to save space in the object file.
8032 @end defmac
8033
8034 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
8035 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8036 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
8037 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
8038 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
8039
8040 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8041 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8042 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8043
8044 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8045 static variables are output.
8046 @end defmac
8047
8048 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8049 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
8050 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
8051 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
8052 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
8053 as the number of bits.
8054 @end defmac
8055
8056 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8057 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
8058 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8059 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8060 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
8061 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
8062 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8063 @end defmac
8064
8065 @node Label Output
8066 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
8067
8068 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8069 This is about outputting labels.
8070
8071 @findex assemble_name
8072 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8073 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8074 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
8075 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8076 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8077 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8078 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8079 @end defmac
8080
8081 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8082 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8083 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
8084 a function.
8085 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8086 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8087 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8088 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8089
8090 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8091 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8092 @end defmac
8093
8094 @findex assemble_name_raw
8095 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8096 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
8097 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
8098 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
8099 that it is more efficient.
8100 @end defmac
8101
8102 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
8103 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8104 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8105 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
8106 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8107
8108 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
8109 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
8110 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
8111 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
8112 define this macro.
8113 @end defmac
8114
8115 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
8116 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8117 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
8118 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8119 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8120 provided.
8121 @end defmac
8122
8123 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8124 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8125 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
8126 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
8127 address.
8128
8129 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8130 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
8131 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
8132 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
8133 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
8134 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
8135 @end defmac
8136
8137 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8138 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8139 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
8140 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
8141 @samp{.} is used instead.
8142 @end defmac
8143
8144 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8145 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8146 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
8147 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
8148 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8149 @end defmac
8150
8151 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
8152 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8153 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8154 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
8155 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8156
8157 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8158 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8159 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8160 types at all, do not define this macro.
8161 @end defmac
8162
8163 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
8164 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
8165 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
8166 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
8167 the default is not to define this macro.
8168
8169 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8170 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8171 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8172 types at all, do not define this macro.
8173 @end defmac
8174
8175 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
8176 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8177 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
8178 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
8179 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
8180 you should not count on this.
8181
8182 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
8183 definition of this macro is provided.
8184 @end defmac
8185
8186 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8187 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8188 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8189 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
8190 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8191 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8192 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8193
8194 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8195 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
8196
8197 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8198 of this macro.
8199 @end defmac
8200
8201 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8202 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8203 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
8204 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8205 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
8206 representing the function.
8207
8208 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
8209
8210 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8211 of this macro.
8212 @end defmac
8213
8214 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8215 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8216 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8217 cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
8218 for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8219 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8220 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8221
8222 If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
8223 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8224
8225 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8226 of this macro.
8227 @end defmac
8228
8229 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8230 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8231 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
8232 partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8233 cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
8234 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8235
8236 If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
8237
8238 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8239 of this macro.
8240 @end defmac
8241
8242 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8243 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8244 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
8245 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
8246 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
8247 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
8248
8249 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
8250 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8251
8252 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8253 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
8254 @end defmac
8255
8256 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
8257 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
8258 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
8259 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8260 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
8261 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
8262 will be an internal label.
8263
8264 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
8265 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
8266
8267 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
8268 @end deftypefn
8269
8270 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
8271 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8272 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
8273 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8274
8275 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8276 nothing.
8277 @end defmac
8278
8279 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
8280 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8281 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8282 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8283 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8284 something about the size of the object.
8285
8286 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8287 nothing.
8288
8289 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8290 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
8291 @end defmac
8292
8293 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8294 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8295 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
8296 that is, available for reference from other files.
8297
8298 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8299 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
8300 @end deftypefn
8301
8302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8303 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8304 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8305 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8306
8307 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8308 @end deftypefn
8309
8310 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8311 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8312 @var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8313 @var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8314 assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8315 @end deftypefn
8316
8317 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8318 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8319 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8320 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8321 no other definition is available. Use the expression
8322 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8323 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8324 for making that name weak, and a newline.
8325
8326 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8327 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8328 macro.
8329 @end defmac
8330
8331 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8332 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8333 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8334 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8335 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8336 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8337 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8338 to make @var{name} weak.
8339 @end defmac
8340
8341 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8342 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8343 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8344 declaration of @code{name}.
8345 @end defmac
8346
8347 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8348 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8349 supports weak symbols.
8350
8351 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8352 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8353 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8354 @end defmac
8355
8356 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8357 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8358
8359 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8360 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8361 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8362 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8363 @end defmac
8364
8365 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8366 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8367 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8368 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8369 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8370 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8371 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8372 @end defmac
8373
8374 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8375 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8376 semantics.
8377
8378 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8379 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8380 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8381 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8382 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8383 be emitted as one-only.
8384 @end defmac
8385
8386 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8387 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8388 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8389 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8390 @end deftypefn
8391
8392 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8393 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8394 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8395 The default is @code{0}.
8396
8397 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8398 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8399 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8400 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8401 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8402 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8403 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8404
8405 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8406 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8407 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8408 table of contents.
8409 @end defmac
8410
8411 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8412 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8413 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8414 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8415 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8416 declaration.
8417
8418 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8419 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8420 @end defmac
8421
8422 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8423 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8424 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8425 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8426 @end deftypefn
8427
8428 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8429 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8430 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8431 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8432 @end deftypefn
8433
8434 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8435 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8436 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8437 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8438 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8439 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8440 @end defmac
8441
8442 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8443 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8444 @end deftypefn
8445
8446 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8447 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8448 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8449 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8450 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8451 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8452 @end defmac
8453
8454 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8455 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8456 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8457 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8458 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8459 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8460 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8461 being taken.
8462 @end defmac
8463
8464 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8465 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8466 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8467
8468 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8469 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8470 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8471
8472 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8473 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8474 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8475 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8476 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8477
8478 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8479 @end deftypefn
8480
8481 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8482 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8483 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8484 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8485 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8486 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8487 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8488 bundles.
8489
8490 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8491 used.
8492 @end defmac
8493
8494 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8495 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8496 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8497
8498 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8499 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8500 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8501
8502 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8503 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8504 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8505 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8506 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8507 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8508 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8509 @end defmac
8510
8511 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8512 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8513 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8514 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8515 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8516
8517 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8518 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8519 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8520 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8521 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8522 internal static variables in different scopes.
8523
8524 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8525 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8526 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8527 between the name and the number will suffice.
8528
8529 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8530 which is correct for most systems.
8531 @end defmac
8532
8533 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8534 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8535 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8536
8537 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8538 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8539 correct for most systems.
8540 @end defmac
8541
8542 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8543 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8544 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8545 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8546 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8547 the tree nodes are available.
8548
8549 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8550 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8551 correct for most systems.
8552 @end defmac
8553
8554 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8555 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8556 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8557 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8558 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8559 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8560 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8561 @end defmac
8562
8563 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8564 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8565 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8566 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8567 an undefined weak symbol.
8568
8569 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8570 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8571 @end defmac
8572
8573 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8574 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8575 Objective-C methods.
8576
8577 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8578 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8579 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8580 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8581
8582 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8583 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8584 systems define other ways of computing names.
8585
8586 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8587 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8588 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8589 50 characters extra.
8590
8591 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8592 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8593 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8594 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8595
8596 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8597 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8598 @end defmac
8599
8600 @node Initialization
8601 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8602 @cindex initialization routines
8603 @cindex termination routines
8604 @cindex constructors, output of
8605 @cindex destructors, output of
8606
8607 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8608 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8609 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8610 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8611 @code{main} is called.
8612
8613 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8614 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8615 terminates.
8616
8617 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8618 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8619 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8620 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8621
8622 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8623 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8624 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8625
8626 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8627 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8628 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8629 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8630 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8631
8632 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8633 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8634 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8635 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8636 pointer containing zero.
8637
8638 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8639 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8640 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8641 list; destructors in forward order.
8642
8643 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8644 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8645 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8646 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8647 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8648 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8649 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8650 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8651
8652 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8653 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8654 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8655 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8656 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8657
8658 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8659 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8660 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8661 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8662 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8663
8664 @smallexample
8665 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8666 @end smallexample
8667
8668 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8669 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8670 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8671 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8672 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8673
8674 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8675 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8676 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8677 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8678 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8679 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8680
8681 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8682 macro properly.
8683
8684 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8685 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8686 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8687 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8688 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8689 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8690
8691 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8692 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8693 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8694 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8695 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8696 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8697 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8698 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8699 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8700 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8701 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8702 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8703 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8704 the initialization process.
8705
8706 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8707 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8708 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8709 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8710 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8711 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8712 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8713 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8714 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8715 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8716 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8717
8718 @ifinfo
8719 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8720 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8721 @end ifinfo
8722
8723 @node Macros for Initialization
8724 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8725
8726 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8727 and termination functions:
8728
8729 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8730 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8731 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8732 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8733 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8734 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8735 run the initialization functions.
8736 @end defmac
8737
8738 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8739 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8740 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8741 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8742 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8743 @end defmac
8744
8745 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8746 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8747 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8748 @end defmac
8749
8750 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8751 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8752 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8753 @end defmac
8754
8755 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8756 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8757 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8758 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8759 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8760 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8761
8762 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8763 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8764 exception tables embedded in the code.
8765 @end defmac
8766
8767 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8768 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8769 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8770 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8771 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8772 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8773 @end defmac
8774
8775 @defmac INVOKE__main
8776 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8777 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8778 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8779 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8780 @end defmac
8781
8782 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8783 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8784 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8785 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8786 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8787 @end defmac
8788
8789 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8790 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8791 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8792 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8793 @end deftypevr
8794
8795 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8796 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8797 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8798
8799 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8800 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8801 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8802 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8803
8804 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8805 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8806 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8807 is not defined.
8808 @end deftypefn
8809
8810 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8811 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8812 functions rather than initialization functions.
8813 @end deftypefn
8814
8815 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8816 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8817
8818 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8819 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8820 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8821
8822 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8823 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8824
8825 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8826 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8827 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8828 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8829
8830 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8831 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8832 @end defmac
8833
8834 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8835 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8836 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8837 @command{nm}.
8838 @end defmac
8839
8840 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8841 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8842 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8843 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8844 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8845 produces.
8846 @end defmac
8847
8848 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8849 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8850 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8851 termination functions in shared libraries:
8852
8853 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8854 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8855 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8856 @end defmac
8857
8858 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8859 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8860 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8861 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8862 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8863 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8864 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8865 @end defmac
8866
8867 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8868 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8869 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8870 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8871 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8872 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8873 @end defmac
8874
8875 @node Instruction Output
8876 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8877
8878 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8879 This describes assembler instruction output.
8880
8881 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8882 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8883 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8884 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8885 @end defmac
8886
8887 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8888 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8889 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8890 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8891 to registers using alternate names.
8892 @end defmac
8893
8894 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8895 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8896 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8897 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8898 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8899 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8900 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8901 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8902
8903 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8904 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8905 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8906 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8907 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8908 @end defmac
8909
8910 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8911 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8912 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8913
8914 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8915 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8916 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8917 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8918 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8919 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8920 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8921 so that it will not be output twice.
8922
8923 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8924 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8925 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8926 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8927 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8928
8929 @findex recog_data.operand
8930 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8931 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8932
8933 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8934 in the usual way.
8935 @end defmac
8936
8937 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8938 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8939 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8940 they will be output differently.
8941
8942 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8943 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8944 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8945 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8946 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8947 by changing the contents of the vector.
8948
8949 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8950 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8951 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8952 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8953 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8954 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8955
8956 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8957 @end defmac
8958
8959 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8960 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8961 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8962 if necessary.
8963
8964 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8965 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8966 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8967 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8968 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8969 by checking the contents of the vector.
8970 @end deftypefn
8971
8972 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8973 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8974 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8975 RTL expression.
8976
8977 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8978 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8979 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8980 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8981 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8982 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8983 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8984
8985 @findex reg_names
8986 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8987 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8988 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8989 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8990
8991 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8992 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8993 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8994 @var{code}.
8995 @end defmac
8996
8997 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8998 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8999 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
9000 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
9001 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
9002 in this way.
9003 @end defmac
9004
9005 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
9006 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
9007 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
9008 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
9009
9010 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
9011 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
9012 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
9013 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
9014 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
9015 Format}.
9016 @end defmac
9017
9018 @findex dbr_sequence_length
9019 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
9020 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
9021 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
9022 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
9023 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
9024 or whatever.
9025
9026 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
9027 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
9028 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
9029 @end defmac
9030
9031 @findex final_sequence
9032 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
9033 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
9034 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
9035 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
9036 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
9037 being output.
9038
9039 @findex asm_fprintf
9040 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
9041 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
9042 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
9043 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
9044 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
9045 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
9046 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
9047 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
9048 files can define these macros differently.
9049 @end defmac
9050
9051 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
9052 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
9053 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
9054 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
9055 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
9056 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
9057 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
9058 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
9059 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
9060 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
9061 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
9062 @end defmac
9063
9064 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
9065 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
9066 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
9067 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
9068 first variant.
9069
9070 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
9071 @smallexample
9072 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
9073 @end smallexample
9074 @noindent
9075 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
9076 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
9077 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
9078 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
9079 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
9080 alternatives within the braces than the value of
9081 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
9082 to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
9083 @samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
9084
9085 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
9086 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
9087 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
9088
9089 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
9090 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
9091 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
9092 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
9093 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
9094 opcodes or operand order.
9095 @end defmac
9096
9097 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9098 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9099 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
9100 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9101 profiling.
9102 @end defmac
9103
9104 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9105 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9106 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
9107 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9108 profiling.
9109 @end defmac
9110
9111 @node Dispatch Tables
9112 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
9113
9114 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9115 This concerns dispatch tables.
9116
9117 @cindex dispatch table
9118 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
9119 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9120 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
9121 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
9122 definitions of these labels are output using
9123 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
9124 way here. For example,
9125
9126 @smallexample
9127 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
9128 @var{value}, @var{rel})
9129 @end smallexample
9130
9131 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
9132 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
9133 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
9134 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
9135 mode and flags can be read.
9136 @end defmac
9137
9138 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
9139 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
9140 in a dispatch table are absolute.
9141
9142 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
9143 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
9144 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
9145 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9146 For example,
9147
9148 @smallexample
9149 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
9150 @end smallexample
9151 @end defmac
9152
9153 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9154 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
9155 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
9156 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
9157 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
9158 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
9159
9160 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
9161 for the table.
9162
9163 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
9164 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9165 @end defmac
9166
9167 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9168 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
9169 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
9170 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
9171 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
9172 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
9173 of the preceding label.
9174
9175 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
9176 the jump-table.
9177 @end defmac
9178
9179 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
9180 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
9181 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
9182 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
9183 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9184 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
9185 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
9186 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
9187
9188 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
9189 @end deftypefn
9190
9191 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
9192 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
9193 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
9194 to be broken up according to function.
9195
9196 The default is that no label is emitted.
9197 @end deftypefn
9198
9199 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
9200 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
9201 @end deftypefn
9202
9203 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9204 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
9205 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9206 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
9207 @end deftypefn
9208
9209 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
9210 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
9211 @end deftypevr
9212
9213 @node Exception Region Output
9214 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
9215
9216 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9217
9218 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
9219 region.
9220
9221 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
9222 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
9223 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
9224 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
9225 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
9226
9227 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
9228 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
9229 @end defmac
9230
9231 @defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
9232 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by
9233 specially named labels. The collect2 process will locate these
9234 labels and generate code to register the frames.
9235
9236 This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not
9237 place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c},
9238 or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot
9239 be marked as not to be collected.
9240 @end defmac
9241
9242 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
9243 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
9244 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
9245 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
9246 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
9247 @end defmac
9248
9249 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
9250 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
9251 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
9252 @end defmac
9253
9254 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
9255 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9256 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
9257 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
9258 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
9259 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
9260 @end defmac
9261
9262 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
9263 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
9264 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
9265 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
9266 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
9267 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9268 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
9269
9270 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
9271 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
9272 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
9273
9274 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
9275 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9276 @var{opts}. In particular, the
9277 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9278 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9279 depending on this setting.
9280
9281 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9282 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
9283 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9284 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9285 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
9286 @end deftypefn
9287
9288 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
9289 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
9290 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9291 command-line option processing.
9292 @end deftypevr
9293
9294 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9295 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9296 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9297 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
9298 @end defmac
9299
9300 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9301 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9302 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9303 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9304 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9305 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9306 @end defmac
9307
9308 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
9309 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9310 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9311 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
9312 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
9313 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
9314 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
9315 @end defmac
9316
9317 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
9318 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9319 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9320 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9321 true otherwise.
9322 @end deftypevr
9323
9324 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9325 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9326 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9327 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9328 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9329 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9330 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9331 @end deftypefn
9332
9333 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
9334 Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9335 corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9336 used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9337 clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9338 @end deftypefn
9339
9340 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9341 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9342 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9343 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9344 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9345 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9346 @var{address} is the address of the table.
9347 @end deftypefn
9348
9349 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9350 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9351 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9352 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9353 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9354 @end deftypefn
9355
9356 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9357 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9358 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9359 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9360 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9361 @end deftypevr
9362
9363 @node Alignment Output
9364 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9365
9366 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9367 This describes commands for alignment.
9368
9369 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9370 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9371 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9372
9373 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9374 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9375 define the macro.
9376
9377 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9378 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9379 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9380 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9381 @end defmac
9382
9383 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9384 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9385 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9386 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9387 @end deftypefn
9388
9389 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9390 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9391 a @code{BARRIER}.
9392
9393 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9394 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9395 define the macro.
9396 @end defmac
9397
9398 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9399 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9400 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9401 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9402 @end deftypefn
9403
9404 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9405 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9406 a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
9407
9408 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9409 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9410 define the macro.
9411
9412 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9413 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9414 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9415 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9416 @end defmac
9417
9418 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9419 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9420 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9421 defined.
9422 @end deftypefn
9423
9424 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9425 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9426 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9427 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9428
9429 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9430 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9431 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9432 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9433 @end defmac
9434
9435 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9436 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9437 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9438 is defined.
9439 @end deftypefn
9440
9441 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9442 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9443 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9444 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9445 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9446 @end defmac
9447
9448 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9449 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9450 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9451 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9452 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9453 section.
9454 @end defmac
9455
9456 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9457 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9458 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9459 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9460 @end defmac
9461
9462 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9463 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9464 for padding, if necessary.
9465 @end defmac
9466
9467 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9468 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9469 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9470 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9471 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9472 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9473 @end defmac
9474
9475 @need 3000
9476 @node Debugging Info
9477 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9478
9479 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9480 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9481
9482 @menu
9483 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9484 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9485 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9486 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9487 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9488 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9489 @end menu
9490
9491 @node All Debuggers
9492 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9493
9494 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9495 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9496
9497 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9498 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9499 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9500 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9501 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9502 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9503 compiler and another for DBX@.
9504
9505 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9506 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9507 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9508 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9509 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9510
9511 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9512 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9513 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9514 @end defmac
9515
9516 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9517 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9518 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9519 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9520 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9521 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9522 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9523 @option{-g} options is used.
9524 @end defmac
9525
9526 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9527 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9528 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9529 @var{offset}.
9530 @end defmac
9531
9532 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9533 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9534 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9535 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9536 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9537 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9538 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9539
9540 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9541 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9542 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9543 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9544 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9545
9546 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9547 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9548 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9549 @end defmac
9550
9551 @node DBX Options
9552 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9553
9554 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9555 These are specific options for DBX output.
9556
9557 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9558 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9559 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9560 @end defmac
9561
9562 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9563 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9564 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9565 @end defmac
9566
9567 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9568 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9569 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9570 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9571 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9572 if there is any occasion to.
9573 @end defmac
9574
9575 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9576 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9577 in the text section.
9578 @end defmac
9579
9580 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9581 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9582 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9583 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9584 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9585 @end defmac
9586
9587 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9588 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9589 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9590 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9591 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9592 information format.
9593 @end defmac
9594
9595 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9596 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9597 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9598 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9599 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9600 @end defmac
9601
9602 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9603 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9604 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9605 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9606 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9607 @end defmac
9608
9609 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9610 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9611 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9612 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9613 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9614 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9615 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9616 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9617 @end defmac
9618
9619 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9620 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9621 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9622 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9623 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9624 if backslash is correct for your system.
9625 @end defmac
9626
9627 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9628 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9629 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9630 variable.
9631 @end defmac
9632
9633 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9634 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9635 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9636 @end defmac
9637
9638 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9639 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9640 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9641 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9642 @end defmac
9643
9644 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9645 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9646 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9647 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9648 @end defmac
9649
9650 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9651 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9652 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9653 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9654 @end defmac
9655
9656 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9657 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9658 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9659 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9660 code.
9661 @end defmac
9662
9663 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9664 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9665 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9666 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9667 an absolute address.
9668 @end defmac
9669
9670 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9671 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9672 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9673 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9674 @end defmac
9675
9676 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9677 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9678 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9679 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9680 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9681 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9682 number for a type number.
9683 @end defmac
9684
9685 @node DBX Hooks
9686 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9687
9688 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9689 These are hooks for DBX format.
9690
9691 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9692 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9693 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9694 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9695 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9696 unique labels in the assembly output.
9697
9698 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9699 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9700 @end defmac
9701
9702 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9703 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9704 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9705 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9706 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9707 @end defmac
9708
9709 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9710 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9711 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9712 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9713 @end defmac
9714
9715 @node File Names and DBX
9716 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9717
9718 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9719 This describes file names in DBX format.
9720
9721 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9722 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9723 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9724 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9725 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9726
9727 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9728 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9729
9730 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9731 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9732 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9733 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9734 @end defmac
9735
9736 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9737 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9738 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9739 the beginning of the file.
9740 @end defmac
9741
9742 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9743 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9744 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9745 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9746 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9747 @end defmac
9748
9749 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9750 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9751 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9752 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9753
9754 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9755 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9756 @end defmac
9757
9758 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9759 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9760 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9761 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9762 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9763 @end defmac
9764
9765 @need 2000
9766 @node SDB and DWARF
9767 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9768
9769 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9770 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9771
9772 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9773 Define this macro to 1 if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9774 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9775 @end defmac
9776
9777 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9778 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9779 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9780
9781 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9782 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9783 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9784 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9785 @end deftypefn
9786
9787 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9788 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9789 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9790 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9791 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9792 @end defmac
9793
9794 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9795 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9796 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9797 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9798 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9799 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9800 @end defmac
9801
9802 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9803 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9804 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9805 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9806 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9807
9808 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9809 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9810
9811 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9812 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9813 @end deftypefn
9814
9815 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9816 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9817 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9818 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9819 @end defmac
9820
9821 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9822 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9823 @end deftypevr
9824
9825 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9826 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
9827 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9828 @end deftypevr
9829
9830 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9831 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
9832 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9833 @end deftypevr
9834
9835 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
9836 True if register allocation and the passes
9837 following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
9838 targets.
9839 @end deftypevr
9840
9841 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9842 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9843 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9844 @end defmac
9845
9846 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9847 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9848 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9849 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9850 @end defmac
9851
9852 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{offset}, @var{section})
9853 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9854 section-relative reference to the given @var{label} plus @var{offset}, using
9855 an integer of the given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the
9856 given @var{section}.
9857 @end defmac
9858
9859 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9860 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9861 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9862 @end defmac
9863
9864 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9865 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the
9866 given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9867 @end defmac
9868
9869 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9870 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9871 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9872 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9873 is referenced by a function.
9874 @end defmac
9875
9876 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9877 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9878 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9879 @end deftypefn
9880
9881 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9882 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9883 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9884 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9885 not define them yourself.
9886 @end defmac
9887
9888 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9889 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9890 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9891 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9892 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9893 required.
9894 @end defmac
9895
9896 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9897 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9898 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9899 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9900 it.
9901 @end defmac
9902
9903 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9904 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9905 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9906 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9907 @end defmac
9908
9909 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9910 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9911 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9912 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9913 @end defmac
9914
9915 @need 2000
9916 @node VMS Debug
9917 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9918
9919 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9920 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9921
9922 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9923 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9924 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9925 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9926 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9927 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9928 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9929 @end defmac
9930
9931 @node Floating Point
9932 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9933 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9934 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9935
9936 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9937 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9938 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9939 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9940 doing the compilation.
9941
9942 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9943 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9944 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9945 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9946 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9947 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9948 target floating point formats are identical.
9949
9950 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9951 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9952 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9953 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9954
9955 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9956 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9957 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9958 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9959 quantity.
9960 @end defmac
9961
9962 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9963 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9964 @end deftypefn
9965
9966 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9967 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9968 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9969 @end deftypefn
9970
9971 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
9972 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9973 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9974 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9975 defined by the C language for both.
9976 @end deftypefn
9977
9978 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9979 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9980 @end deftypefn
9981
9982 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9983 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9984 @end deftypefn
9985
9986 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9987 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9988 @end deftypefn
9989
9990 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9991 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9992 @end deftypefn
9993
9994 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9995 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9996 @end deftypefn
9997
9998 @node Mode Switching
9999 @section Mode Switching Instructions
10000 @cindex mode switching
10001 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
10002
10003 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
10004 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
10005 switching in an optimizing compilation.
10006
10007 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
10008 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
10009 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
10010 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
10011 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
10012 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you cannot put this into instruction emitting
10013 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
10014
10015 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
10016 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
10017 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
10018 If you define this macro, you also have to define
10019 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
10020 @code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
10021 @code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
10022 are optional.
10023 @end defmac
10024
10025 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
10026 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
10027 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
10028 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
10029 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
10030 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
10031 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
10032 entity in question.
10033 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
10034 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
10035 switch is needed / supplied.
10036 @end defmac
10037
10038 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
10039 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
10040 @end deftypefn
10041
10042 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10043 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
10044 @end deftypefn
10045
10046 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10047 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
10048 @end deftypefn
10049
10050 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
10051 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
10052 @end deftypefn
10053
10054 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
10055 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
10056 @end deftypefn
10057
10058 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
10059 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
10060 @end deftypefn
10061
10062 @node Target Attributes
10063 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
10064 @cindex target attributes
10065 @cindex machine attributes
10066 @cindex attributes, target-specific
10067
10068 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
10069 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
10070 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
10071
10072 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
10073 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
10074 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
10075 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
10076 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
10077 take.
10078 @end deftypevr
10079
10080 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
10081 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
10082 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
10083 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
10084 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
10085 false for all machine-specific attributes.
10086 @end deftypefn
10087
10088 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
10089 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
10090 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
10091 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
10092 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
10093 supposed always to be compatible.
10094 @end deftypefn
10095
10096 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
10097 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
10098 the newly defined @var{type}.
10099 @end deftypefn
10100
10101 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
10102 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
10103 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10104 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
10105 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
10106 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
10107 merging.
10108 @end deftypefn
10109
10110 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
10111 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
10112 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10113 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
10114 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
10115 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
10116 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
10117 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
10118
10119 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
10120 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
10121 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
10122 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
10123 will then define a function called
10124 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
10125 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
10126 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
10127 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
10128 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
10129 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
10130 @end deftypefn
10131
10132 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
10133 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
10134 @end deftypefn
10135
10136 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
10137 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
10138 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
10139 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
10140 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
10141 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
10142 on this implementation detail.
10143 @end defmac
10144
10145 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
10146 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
10147 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
10148 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
10149 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
10150 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
10151 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
10152 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
10153 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
10154 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
10155 needed.
10156 @end deftypefn
10157
10158 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
10159 @cindex inlining
10160 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
10161 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
10162 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
10163 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
10164 @end deftypefn
10165
10166 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
10167 This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
10168 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
10169 These function-specific options may differ
10170 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
10171 @code{true} if the options are valid.
10172
10173 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
10174 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
10175 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
10176 @end deftypefn
10177
10178 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
10179 This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
10180 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
10181 options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10182 @xref{Option file format}.
10183 @end deftypefn
10184
10185 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10186 This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
10187 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10188 function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10189 @end deftypefn
10190
10191 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10192 This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
10193 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
10194 LTO bytecode.
10195 @end deftypefn
10196
10197 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10198 This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
10199 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10200 function-specific options.
10201 @end deftypefn
10202
10203 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
10204 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
10205 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
10206 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
10207 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
10208 @end deftypefn
10209
10210 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
10211 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
10212 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
10213 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
10214 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
10215
10216 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
10217 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
10218
10219 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
10220 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
10221 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
10222 @end deftypefn
10223
10224 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10225 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
10226 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
10227 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
10228 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
10229 different target machines.
10230 @end deftypefn
10231
10232 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
10233 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
10234 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
10235 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
10236 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
10237 @end deftypefn
10238
10239 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl})
10240 This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.
10241 @end deftypefn
10242
10243 @node Emulated TLS
10244 @section Emulating TLS
10245 @cindex Emulated TLS
10246
10247 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
10248 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
10249 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
10250 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
10251 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
10252 layer.
10253
10254 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10255 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10256 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10257 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10258
10259 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10260 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10261 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10262 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10263 @end deftypevr
10264
10265 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10266 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10267 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10268 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10269 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10270 registration function to be used.
10271 @end deftypevr
10272
10273 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10274 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10275 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10276 any section.
10277 @end deftypevr
10278
10279 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10280 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10281 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10282 section.
10283 @end deftypevr
10284
10285 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10286 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10287 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10288 @end deftypevr
10289
10290 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10291 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10292 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10293 @end deftypevr
10294
10295 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10296 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10297 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10298 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10299 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10300 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10301 @end deftypefn
10302
10303 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10304 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10305 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10306 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10307 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10308 @end deftypefn
10309
10310 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10311 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10312 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10313 single objects. The default is false.
10314 @end deftypevr
10315
10316 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10317 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10318 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10319 @end deftypevr
10320
10321 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10322 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10323 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10324
10325 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10326 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10327 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10328 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10329
10330 @smallexample
10331 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10332 unsigned int d;
10333
10334 d = cp0count + 3;
10335 @end smallexample
10336
10337 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10338 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10339 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10340
10341 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10342 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10343 later in the function.
10344
10345 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10346 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10347 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10348
10349 @node PCH Target
10350 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10351 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10352
10353 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10354 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10355 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10356 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10357 @end deftypefn
10358
10359 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10360 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10361 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10362 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10363 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10364
10365 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10366 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10367 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10368 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10369
10370 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10371 suitable for most targets.
10372 @end deftypefn
10373
10374 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10375 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10376 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10377 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10378 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10379 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10380 @end deftypefn
10381
10382 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10383 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10384 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10385 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10386 to do anything here.
10387 @end deftypefn
10388
10389 @node C++ ABI
10390 @section C++ ABI parameters
10391 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10392
10393 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10394 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10395 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10396 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10397 @end deftypefn
10398
10399 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10400 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10401 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10402 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10403 @end deftypefn
10404
10405 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10406 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10407 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10408 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10409 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10410 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10411 @end deftypefn
10412
10413 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10414 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10415 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10416 @end deftypefn
10417
10418 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10419 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10420 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10421 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10422 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10423 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10424 backend's targeted operating system.
10425 @end deftypefn
10426
10427 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10428 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10429 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10430 @code{false}.
10431 @end deftypefn
10432
10433 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10434 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10435 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10436 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10437 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10438 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10439 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10440 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10441 @end deftypefn
10442
10443 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10444 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10445 @end deftypefn
10446
10447 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10448 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10449 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10450 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10451 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10452 unit will not be COMDAT.
10453 @end deftypefn
10454
10455 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10456 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10457 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10458 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10459 @end deftypefn
10460
10461 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10462 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10463 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10464 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10465 @end deftypefn
10466
10467 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10468 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10469 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10470 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10471 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10472 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10473 @end deftypefn
10474
10475 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10476 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10477 @end deftypefn
10478
10479 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10480 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10481 @end deftypefn
10482
10483 @node Named Address Spaces
10484 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10485 @cindex named address spaces
10486
10487 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10488 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10489 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10490 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10491 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10492 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10493 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10494 @code{const} type attributes.
10495
10496 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10497 pointers to the generic address space.
10498
10499 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10500 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10501 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10502 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10503 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10504 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10505 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10506 always 32 bits).
10507
10508 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10509 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10510 address space.
10511
10512 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10513 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10514 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10515 named address space #1:
10516 @smallexample
10517 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10518 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10519 @end smallexample
10520
10521 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10522 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10523 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10524 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.
10525 @end deftypefn
10526
10527 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10528 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10529 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10530 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.
10531 @end deftypefn
10532
10533 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10534 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10535 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10536 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10537 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10538 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10539 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10540 target hooks for the given address space.
10541 @end deftypefn
10542
10543 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10544 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10545 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10546 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10547 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10548 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10549 explicit named address space support.
10550 @end deftypefn
10551
10552 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10553 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10554 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10555 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10556 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10557 @end deftypefn
10558
10559 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10560 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10561 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10562 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10563 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10564 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10565 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10566 @end deftypefn
10567
10568 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as})
10569 Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the
10570 address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.
10571 @end deftypefn
10572
10573 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10574 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10575 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10576 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10577 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10578 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10579 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10580 @end deftypefn
10581
10582 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as})
10583 Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.
10584 The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.
10585 @end deftypefn
10586
10587 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DIAGNOSE_USAGE (addr_space_t @var{as}, location_t @var{loc})
10588 Define this hook if the availability of an address space depends on
10589 command line options and some diagnostics should be printed when the
10590 address space is used. This hook is called during parsing and allows
10591 to emit a better diagnostic compared to the case where the address space
10592 was not registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}. @var{as} is
10593 the address space as registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}.
10594 @var{loc} is the location of the address space qualifier token.
10595 The default implementation does nothing.
10596 @end deftypefn
10597
10598 @node Misc
10599 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10600 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10601
10602 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10603 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10604
10605 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10606 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10607 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10608 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10609 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10610 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10611 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10612 @end defmac
10613
10614 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10615 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10616 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10617 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10618 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10619 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10620 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10621 @end defmac
10622
10623 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10624 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10625 elements of a jump-table should have.
10626 @end defmac
10627
10628 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10629 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10630 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10631 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10632 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10633 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10634 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10635 flags can be updated.
10636 @end defmac
10637
10638 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10639 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10640 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10641 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10642 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10643 is in effect.
10644 @end defmac
10645
10646 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10647 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10648 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10649 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10650 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10651 @end deftypefn
10652
10653 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10654 Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
10655 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10656 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10657 @end defmac
10658
10659 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_ARITHMETIC_PRECISION (void)
10660 On some RISC architectures with 64-bit registers, the processor also
10661 maintains 32-bit condition codes that make it possible to do real 32-bit
10662 arithmetic, although the operations are performed on the full registers.
10663
10664 On such architectures, defining this hook to 32 tells the compiler to try
10665 using 32-bit arithmetical operations setting the condition codes instead
10666 of doing full 64-bit arithmetic.
10667
10668 More generally, define this hook on RISC architectures if you want the
10669 compiler to try using arithmetical operations setting the condition codes
10670 with a precision lower than the word precision.
10671
10672 You need not define this hook if @code{WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS} is not
10673 defined to 1.
10674 @end deftypefn
10675
10676 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10677 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10678 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10679 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10680 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10681 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10682 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10683 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10684
10685 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10686 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10687 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10688 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10689 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10690
10691 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10692 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10693 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10694 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10695 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10696
10697 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10698 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10699 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10700 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10701 @end defmac
10702
10703 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10704 Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10705 extends.
10706 @end defmac
10707
10708 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
10709 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10710 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10711 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10712 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10713 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10714 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10715 @end deftypefn
10716
10717 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10718 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10719 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10720 @end defmac
10721
10722 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10723 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10724 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10725 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10726 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10727 at run-time.
10728 @end defmac
10729
10730 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10731 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10732 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10733 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10734 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10735 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10736 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10737 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10738 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10739 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10740 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10741
10742 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10743 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10744 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10745
10746 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10747 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10748 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10749 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10750 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10751
10752 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10753 @end defmac
10754
10755 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10756 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
10757 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10758 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10759 @xref{shift patterns}.
10760
10761 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10762 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10763 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10764 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10765 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10766 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10767
10768 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10769 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10770 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10771
10772 The default implementation of this function returns
10773 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10774 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10775 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10776 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10777 by overriding it.
10778 @end deftypefn
10779
10780 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10781 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10782 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10783 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10784 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10785
10786 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10787
10788 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10789 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10790 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10791 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10792 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10793 such cases may improve things.
10794 @end defmac
10795
10796 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10797 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10798 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10799 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10800 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10801 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10802 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10803 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10804 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10805 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10806 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10807
10808 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10809 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10810 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10811 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10812
10813 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10814 describe two related properties. If you define
10815 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10816 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10817 extension.
10818
10819 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10820 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10821 @code{mode}.
10822 @end deftypefn
10823
10824 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10825 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10826 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10827 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10828 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10829 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10830
10831 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10832 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10833 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10834 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10835 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10836 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10837 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10838 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10839 the compiler.
10840
10841 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10842 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10843 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10844 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10845 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10846 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10847 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10848 expression
10849
10850 @smallexample
10851 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10852 @end smallexample
10853
10854 @noindent
10855 can be converted to
10856
10857 @smallexample
10858 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10859 @end smallexample
10860
10861 @noindent
10862 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10863 tested into the sign bit.
10864
10865 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10866 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10867 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10868 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10869 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10870 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10871
10872 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10873 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10874 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10875 to be used:
10876
10877 @itemize @bullet
10878 @item
10879 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10880 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10881 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10882 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10883 combine the normalization with other operations.
10884
10885 @item
10886 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10887 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10888 other machines.
10889
10890 @item
10891 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10892 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10893 others.
10894
10895 @item
10896 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10897 @end itemize
10898
10899 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10900 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10901 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10902 those cases, e.g., one matching
10903
10904 @smallexample
10905 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10906 @end smallexample
10907
10908 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10909 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10910 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10911 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10912 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10913 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10914 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10915 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10916
10917 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10918 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10919 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10920 @end defmac
10921
10922 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10923 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10924 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10925 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10926 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10927 this macro.
10928 @end defmac
10929
10930 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10931 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10932 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10933 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10934 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10935 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10936 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10937 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10938 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10939 given mode.
10940 @end defmac
10941
10942 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10943 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10944 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10945 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10946 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10947 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10948 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10949 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10950 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10951 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10952 this value.
10953
10954 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10955 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10956
10957 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10958 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10959 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10960 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10961
10962 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10963 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10964 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10965 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10966 breaking the API@.
10967 @end defmac
10968
10969 @defmac Pmode
10970 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10971 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10972 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10973 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10974 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10975
10976 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10977 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10978 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10979 to @code{Pmode}.
10980 @end defmac
10981
10982 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10983 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10984 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10985 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10986 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10987 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10988 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10989 @end defmac
10990
10991 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10992 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10993 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10994 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10995 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10996 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10997
10998 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10999 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
11000 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
11001 @end defmac
11002
11003 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
11004 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
11005
11006 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
11007 @end deftypefn
11008
11009 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
11010 Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
11011 @end deftypefn
11012
11013 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
11014 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
11015 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
11016 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
11017 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
11018 @end defmac
11019
11020 @findex #pragma
11021 @findex pragma
11022 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
11023 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
11024 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
11025 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
11026 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
11027 setup required for the pragmas.
11028
11029 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
11030 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
11031 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
11032
11033 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
11034 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
11035
11036 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
11037 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
11038 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
11039 @end defmac
11040
11041 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11042 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11043
11044 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
11045 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
11046 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
11047 pragma of the form
11048
11049 @smallexample
11050 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
11051 @end smallexample
11052
11053 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
11054 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
11055 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
11056 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
11057 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
11058 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
11059 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
11060 arguments of pragmas registered with
11061 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
11062 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
11063
11064 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
11065 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
11066 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
11067 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
11068 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
11069 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
11070 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
11071 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
11072 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
11073 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
11074 how to build this object file.
11075 @end deftypefun
11076
11077 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
11078 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
11079 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
11080 @end defmac
11081
11082 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
11083 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
11084 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
11085 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
11086 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
11087 @end defmac
11088
11089 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
11090 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
11091 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
11092 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
11093 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
11094 @end defmac
11095
11096 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11097 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11098 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11099 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
11100 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
11101 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
11102 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
11103 you should define this macro.
11104
11105 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11106 @end defmac
11107
11108 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11109 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11110 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11111 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
11112 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
11113 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
11114 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
11115 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
11116 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
11117 slot of @var{insn}.
11118
11119 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11120 @end defmac
11121
11122 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
11123 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
11124 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
11125 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
11126 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
11127 from shared libraries (DLLs).
11128
11129 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
11130 @end defmac
11131
11132 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
11133 This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
11134 @var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
11135 clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
11136 to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
11137
11138 It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
11139 as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
11140 a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
11141 @end deftypefn
11142
11143 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
11144 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
11145 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
11146 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
11147 separate math library.
11148
11149 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
11150 @end defmac
11151
11152 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
11153 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
11154 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
11155
11156 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
11157 is wrong.
11158 @end defmac
11159
11160 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
11161 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
11162 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
11163 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
11164 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
11165 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
11166 for cross-profiling.
11167 @end defmac
11168
11169 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
11170
11171 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
11172 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
11173 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
11174 1 if it does use cc0.
11175 @end defmac
11176
11177 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11178 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
11179 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
11180 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
11181 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
11182 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
11183 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
11184 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
11185 @end defmac
11186
11187 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11188 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
11189 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
11190 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
11191 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
11192 @end defmac
11193
11194 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
11195 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
11196 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
11197 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
11198 about the currently processed blocks.
11199 @end defmac
11200
11201 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
11202 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
11203 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11204 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11205 to by @var{ce_info}.
11206 @end defmac
11207
11208 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
11209 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
11210 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11211 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11212 to by @var{ce_info}.
11213 @end defmac
11214
11215 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
11216 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
11217 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11218 to by @var{ce_info}.
11219 @end defmac
11220
11221 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
11222 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
11223 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
11224 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
11225
11226 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
11227 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
11228 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
11229 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
11230
11231 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
11232 definition is null.
11233 @end deftypefn
11234
11235 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
11236 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11237 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
11238 necessary setup.
11239
11240 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
11241 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
11242 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
11243 instructions or prefetch instructions).
11244
11245 To create a built-in function, call the function
11246 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
11247 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
11248 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
11249 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
11250 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
11251 @end deftypefn
11252
11253 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
11254 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11255 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
11256 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
11257 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
11258 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
11259 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
11260 @code{error_mark_node}.
11261 @end deftypefn
11262
11263 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
11264
11265 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11266 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
11267 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
11268 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
11269 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
11270 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
11271 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
11272 built-in function.
11273 @end deftypefn
11274
11275 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_CHKP_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{fcode})
11276 This hook allows target to redefine built-in functions used by
11277 Pointer Bounds Checker for code instrumentation. Hook should return
11278 fndecl of function implementing generic builtin whose code is
11279 passed in @var{fcode}. Currently following built-in functions are
11280 obtained using this hook:
11281 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndmk (const void *@var{lb}, size_t @var{size})
11282 Function code - BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDMK. This built-in function is used
11283 by Pointer Bounds Checker to create bound values. @var{lb} holds low
11284 bound of the resulting bounds. @var{size} holds size of created bounds.
11285 @end deftypefn
11286
11287 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndstx (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, const void **@var{loc})
11288 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDSTX}. This built-in function is used
11289 by Pointer Bounds Checker to store bounds @var{b} for pointer @var{ptr}
11290 when @var{ptr} is stored by address @var{loc}.
11291 @end deftypefn
11292
11293 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndldx (const void **@var{loc}, const void *@var{ptr})
11294 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDLDX}. This built-in function is used
11295 by Pointer Bounds Checker to get bounds of pointer @var{ptr} loaded by
11296 address @var{loc}.
11297 @end deftypefn
11298
11299 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcl (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11300 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCL}. This built-in function is used
11301 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11302 lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11303 @end deftypefn
11304
11305 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcu (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11306 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCU}. This built-in function is used
11307 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11308 upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11309 @end deftypefn
11310
11311 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndret (void *@var{ptr})
11312 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDRET}. This built-in function is used
11313 by Pointer Bounds Checker to obtain bounds returned by a call statement.
11314 @var{ptr} passed to built-in is @code{SSA_NAME} returned by the call.
11315 @end deftypefn
11316
11317 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_intersect (__bounds_type @var{b1}, __bounds_type @var{b2})
11318 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_INTERSECT}. This built-in function
11319 returns intersection of bounds @var{b1} and @var{b2}.
11320 @end deftypefn
11321
11322 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_narrow (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, size_t @var{s})
11323 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_NARROW}. This built-in function
11324 returns intersection of bounds @var{b} and
11325 [@var{ptr}, @var{ptr} + @var{s} - @code{1}].
11326 @end deftypefn
11327
11328 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} size_t __chkp_sizeof (const void *@var{ptr})
11329 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_SIZEOF}. This built-in function
11330 returns size of object referenced by @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} is always
11331 @code{ADDR_EXPR} of @code{VAR_DECL}. This built-in is used by
11332 Pointer Bounds Checker when bounds of object cannot be computed statically
11333 (e.g. object has incomplete type).
11334 @end deftypefn
11335
11336 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_lower (__bounds_type @var{b})
11337 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_LOWER}. This built-in function
11338 returns lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11339 @end deftypefn
11340
11341 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_upper (__bounds_type @var{b})
11342 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_UPPER}. This built-in function
11343 returns upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11344 @end deftypefn
11345 @end deftypefn
11346 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_TYPE (void)
11347 Return type to be used for bounds
11348 @end deftypefn
11349 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_MODE (void)
11350 Return mode to be used for bounds.
11351 @end deftypefn
11352 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_MAKE_BOUNDS_CONSTANT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{lb}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{ub})
11353 Return constant used to statically initialize constant bounds
11354 with specified lower bound @var{lb} and upper bounds @var{ub}.
11355 @end deftypefn
11356 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CHKP_INITIALIZE_BOUNDS (tree @var{var}, tree @var{lb}, tree @var{ub}, tree *@var{stmts})
11357 Generate a list of statements @var{stmts} to initialize pointer
11358 bounds variable @var{var} with bounds @var{lb} and @var{ub}. Return
11359 the number of generated statements.
11360 @end deftypefn
11361
11362 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
11363 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11364 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11365 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11366 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11367 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11368 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11369 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11370 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
11371 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
11372 @end deftypefn
11373
11374 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
11375 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11376 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
11377 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11378 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
11379 The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11380 containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11381 @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11382 @end deftypefn
11383
11384 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11385 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11386 by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11387 statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11388 was made to the GIMPLE stream.
11389 @end deftypefn
11390
11391 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11392 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11393 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11394 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11395 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11396 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11397 the two function decls that will be compared.
11398 @end deftypefn
11399
11400 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11401 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11402 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11403 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11404 identical versions.
11405 @end deftypefn
11406
11407 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11408 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11409 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11410 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11411 body must be generated.
11412 @end deftypefn
11413
11414 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
11415 Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11416 and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11417 exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11418 the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11419 the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11420 contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11421 loop is only entered from the top.
11422
11423 This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11424 implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11425 if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11426 @end deftypefn
11427
11428 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11429
11430 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
11431 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11432 could not be applied.
11433
11434 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11435 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
11436 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
11437 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
11438 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
11439 @end deftypefn
11440
11441 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11442 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11443 @end deftypefn
11444
11445 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
11446 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11447 @end deftypefn
11448
11449 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11450 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11451 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11452 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11453 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11454 @end deftypefn
11455
11456 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11457
11458 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11459 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11460 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11461 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11462 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11463 that had its initial value copied by using
11464 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11465 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11466 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11467 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11468 @code{MEM}.
11469 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11470 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11471 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11472 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11473 register in question will not be clobbered.
11474 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11475 allocation.
11476 @end deftypefn
11477
11478 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11479 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11480 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11481 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11482 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11483 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11484 passed along.
11485 @end deftypefn
11486
11487 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11488 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11489 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11490 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11491 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11492 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11493 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11494 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11495 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11496 The default hook function does nothing.
11497
11498 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11499 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11500 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11501 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11502 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11503 outside of any function scope.
11504 @end deftypefn
11505
11506 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11507 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11508 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11509 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11510 @end defmac
11511
11512 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11513 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11514 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11515 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11516 executable files.
11517 @end defmac
11518
11519 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11520 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11521 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11522 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11523 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11524 lists.
11525 @end defmac
11526
11527 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11528 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11529 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11530 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11531 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11532 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11533 defined as this expression:
11534
11535 @smallexample
11536 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11537 build_tree_list
11538 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11539 NULL))
11540 @end smallexample
11541 @end defmac
11542
11543 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11544 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11545 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11546 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11547 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11548
11549 @smallexample
11550 static bool
11551 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11552 @{
11553 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11554 @}
11555 @end smallexample
11556 @end deftypefn
11557
11558 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11559 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11560 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11561 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11562 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11563 to inter-block scheduling.
11564 @end deftypefn
11565
11566 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11567 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11568 registers
11569 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11570 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11571 that all target registers in the class returned by
11572 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11573 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11574 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11575 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11576 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11577 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11578 @end deftypefn
11579
11580 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11581 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11582 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11583 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11584 @end deftypefn
11585
11586 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11587 This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11588 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns an appropriate comparison
11589 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11590 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11591 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11592 compares in the the conditional comparision are generated without error.
11593 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11594 @end deftypefn
11595
11596 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11597 This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence
11598 of conditional comparisons. It returns an appropriate comparison with
11599 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11600 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11601 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11602 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error. The
11603 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first}
11604 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of
11605 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must
11606 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11607 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11608 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares.
11609 @end deftypefn
11610
11611 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11612 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11613 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11614 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11615 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11616 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11617 number of memory accesses.
11618 @end deftypefn
11619
11620 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11621 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11622 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11623 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11624 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11625 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11626 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11627 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11628 @end defmac
11629
11630 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11631 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11632 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11633 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11634 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11635 @end deftypefn
11636
11637 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11638 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11639 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11640 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11641 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11642 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11643 @end deftypefn
11644
11645 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11646 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11647 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11648 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11649 that are different from @option{-I}.
11650 @end deftypefn
11651
11652 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11653 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11654 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11655 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11656 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11657 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11658 @end defmac
11659
11660 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11661 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11662 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11663 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11664 @end defmac
11665
11666 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11667 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11668 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11669 @end defmac
11670
11671 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11672 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11673 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11674 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11675 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11676 @end defmac
11677
11678 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11679 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11680 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11681 @end defmac
11682
11683 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11684 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11685 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11686 and scanf formatter settings.
11687 @end defmac
11688
11689 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11690 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11691 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11692 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11693 @end deftypefn
11694
11695 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11696 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11697 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11698 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11699 @end deftypefn
11700
11701 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11702 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11703 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11704 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11705 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11706 @end deftypefn
11707
11708 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11709 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11710 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11711 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11712 the front end.
11713 @end deftypefn
11714
11715 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11716 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11717 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11718 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11719 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11720 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11721 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11722 @end deftypefn
11723
11724 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11725 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11726 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11727 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11728 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11729 conversion rules.
11730 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11731 @end deftypefn
11732
11733 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11734 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11735 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11736 @end defmac
11737
11738 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11739 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11740 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11741 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11742 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11743 @end defmac
11744
11745 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11746 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11747 necessary.
11748 @end deftypefn
11749
11750 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11751 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11752 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11753 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11754 is needed.
11755 @end deftypefn
11756
11757 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11758 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11759 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11760 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11761 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11762 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11763 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11764 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11765 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11766 @end deftypefn
11767
11768 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11769 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11770 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11771 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11772 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11773 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11774 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11775 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11776 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11777 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11778 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11779 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11780 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11781 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11782 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11783 is zero, which disables this optimization.
11784 @end deftypevr
11785
11786 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11787 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11788 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11789 supported by the target.
11790 @end deftypefn
11791
11792 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11793 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11794 memory model bits are allowed.
11795 @end deftypefn
11796
11797 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11798 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11799 @end deftypevr
11800
11801 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11802 It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11803 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11804 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11805 @end deftypefn
11806
11807 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
11808 If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
11809 @end deftypefn
11810
11811 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
11812 ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
11813 @end deftypefn
11814
11815 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
11816 Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
11817 sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
11818 recorded in the offload function and variable table.
11819 @end deftypefn
11820
11821 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
11822 Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
11823 translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
11824 into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
11825 to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
11826 separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
11827
11828 @end deftypefn
11829
11830 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
11831
11832 On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
11833 objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
11834 to indicate that large integers are stored in
11835 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
11836 very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
11837 is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
11838 representation.
11839
11840 Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
11841 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
11842 code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
11843 const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
11844 need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
11845
11846 @itemize @bullet
11847 @item
11848 There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
11849 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
11850 language since there are a variable number of elements.
11851
11852 Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
11853 value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
11854 since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
11855 are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
11856 instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
11857 However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
11858 code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
11859 not really a large change.
11860
11861 @item
11862 Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
11863 constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
11864 port in this code.
11865
11866 @item
11867 The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
11868 constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
11869 @end itemize
11870
11871 All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
11872 maintainer is familiar with.
11873
11874 @end defmac
11875
11876 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RUN_TARGET_SELFTESTS (void)
11877 If selftests are enabled, run any selftests for this target.
11878 @end deftypefn